blob: cc397e1884c09ddef774af656444ba5dee418859 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaucfe14662017-11-19 09:55:29 +01007 2017/11/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000271 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000321Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200545 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200546 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100548 - presetenv
549 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550 - uid
551 - ulimit-n
552 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100553 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200554 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200555 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
556 - ssl-default-bind-options
557 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
558 - ssl-default-server-options
559 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100560 - ssl-server-verify
Christopher Faulet62519022017-10-16 15:49:32 +0200561 - thread-map
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100562 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100563 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100564 - 51degrees-data-file
565 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200566 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200567 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100568 - wurfl-data-file
569 - wurfl-information-list
570 - wurfl-information-list-separator
571 - wurfl-engine-mode
572 - wurfl-cache-size
573 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100574
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200576 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200578 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100579 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100580 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100581 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200582 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200583 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200584 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - noepoll
587 - nokqueue
588 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100589 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300590 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000591 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200592 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200593 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200594 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000595 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000596 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200597 - tune.buffers.limit
598 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200599 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200600 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100601 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200602 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200603 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200604 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100605 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200606 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200607 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100608 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100609 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100610 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100611 - tune.lua.session-timeout
612 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200613 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100614 - tune.maxaccept
615 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200616 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200617 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200618 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100619 - tune.rcvbuf.client
620 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100621 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100622 - tune.sndbuf.client
623 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100624 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100625 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200626 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100627 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200628 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200629 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100630 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200631 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100632 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200633 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
634 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
635 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100636 - tune.zlib.memlevel
637 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100638
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639 * Debugging
640 - debug
641 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642
643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006443.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645------------------------------------
646
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200647ca-base <dir>
648 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200649 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
650 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200651
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200652chroot <jail dir>
653 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
654 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
655 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
656 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
657 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
658 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100659
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100660cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
661 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
662 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
663 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100664 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
665 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
666 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
667 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
668 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
669 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
670 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
671 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
672 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
673 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100674
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200675crt-base <dir>
676 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
677 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
678 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
679
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200680daemon
681 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
682 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100683 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
684 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200686deviceatlas-json-file <path>
687 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
688 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
689
690deviceatlas-log-level <value>
691 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
692 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
693
694deviceatlas-separator <char>
695 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
696 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
697
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100698deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200699 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
700 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
701 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100702
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900703external-check
704 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
705 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
706 See "option external-check".
707
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200708gid <number>
709 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
710 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
711 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100712 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
713 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200714 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100715
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100716hard-stop-after <time>
717 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
718
719 Arguments :
720 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
721 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
722 SIGUSR1 signal.
723
724 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
725 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
726 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
727
728 Example:
729 global
730 hard-stop-after 30s
731
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200732group <group name>
733 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
734 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100735
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200736log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
738 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100739 configured with "log global".
740
741 <address> can be one of:
742
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100743 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100744 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
745 port).
746
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100747 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
748 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
749 port).
750
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100751 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
752 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
753 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
754 writeable).
755
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200756 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
757 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100758
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200759 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
760 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
761 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
762 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
763 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
764 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
765 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
766 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
767 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
768 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200769 JSON-formated logs may require larger values. You may also need to
770 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request uris are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200771
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200772 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
773 one of the following :
774
775 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
776 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
777
778 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
779 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
780
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100781 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200782
783 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
784 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
785 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
786
787 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200788 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
789 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
790 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
791 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
792 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
793 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200794
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200795 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200796
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100797log-send-hostname [<string>]
798 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
799 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
800 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
801 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
802 the logs.
803
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000804log-tag <string>
805 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
806 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
807 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100808 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000809
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100810lua-load <file>
811 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
812 used multiple times.
813
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200814master-worker [exit-on-failure]
815 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
816 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
817 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
818 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
819 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
820 systemd.
821 The "exit-on-failure" option allows the master to kill every workers and
822 exit when one of the current workers died. It is convenient to combine this
823 option with Restart=on-failure in a systemd unit file in order to relaunch
824 the whole process.
825
826 See alors "-W" in the management guide.
827
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200828nbproc <number>
829 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
830 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
831 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
832 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
833 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
834
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200835nbthread <number>
836 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
837 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
838 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
839 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
840 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
841
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200842pidfile <pidfile>
843 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
844 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
845 starting the process. See also "daemon".
846
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100847presetenv <name> <value>
848 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
849 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
850 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
851 and "unsetenv".
852
853resetenv [<name> ...]
854 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
855 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
856 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
857 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
858 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
859 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
860 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
861 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
862
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100863stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200864 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
865 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
866 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
867 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
868 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
869 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100870 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200871 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
872 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200873
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200874server-state-base <directory>
875 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200876 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
877 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200878
879server-state-file <file>
880 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
881 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
882 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
883 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
884 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
885 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
886 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
887 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200888 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
889 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200890
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100891setenv <name> <value>
892 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
893 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
894 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
895 and "unsetenv".
896
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100897ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
899 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300900 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100901 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
902 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
903 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
904 "bind" keyword for more information.
905
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100906ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
907 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
908 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
909 keyword to see available options.
910
911 Example:
912 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +0200913 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100914
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100915ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
917 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300918 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100919 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
920 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
921 information.
922
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100923ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
924 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
925 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
926 keyword to see available options.
927
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200928ssl-dh-param-file <file>
929 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
930 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
931 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
932 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
933 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200934 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
935 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
936 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
937 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200938 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
939 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
940 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
941
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100942ssl-server-verify [none|required]
943 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
944 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
945 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
946
Christopher Faulet62519022017-10-16 15:49:32 +0200947
948thread-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <"all"|"odd"|"even"|thread_num> <cpu-set>...
949 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
950 binds a thread to a specific CPU set. The process must be specified to allow
951 different mapping for different processes. For details about the arguments,
952 see "cpu-map" directive. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its
953 mapping and the one of the process on which it is attached. If the
954 intersection is null, no specific bind will be set for the thread.
955
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200956stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
957 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
958 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
959 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +0200960 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200961 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200962
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200963 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
964 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
965 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200966
967stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
968 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
969 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100970 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200971
972stats maxconn <connections>
973 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
974 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
975
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200976uid <number>
977 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
978 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
979 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
980 one. See also "gid" and "user".
981
982ulimit-n <number>
983 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
984 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
985 option.
986
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100987unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
988 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
989
990 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
991 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
992 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
993 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
994 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
995 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
996 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
997 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
998 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
999 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1000
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001001unsetenv [<name> ...]
1002 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1003 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1004 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1005 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1006 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1007 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1008 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1009
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001010user <user name>
1011 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1012 See also "uid" and "group".
1013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001014node <name>
1015 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1016
1017 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1018 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1019 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1020 traffic.
1021
1022description <text>
1023 Add a text that describes the instance.
1024
1025 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1026 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1027 "<" and ">" characters.
1028
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100102951degrees-data-file <file path>
1030 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1031 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
1032
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001033 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001034 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1035
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000103651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001037 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1038 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1039 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1040
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001041 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001042 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1043
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200104451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001045 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1046 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1047
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001048 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1049 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1050
105151degrees-cache-size <number>
1052 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1053 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1054 By default, this cache is disabled.
1055
1056 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001057 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1058
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001059wurfl-data-file <file path>
1060 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1061 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1062
1063 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1064 with USE_WURFL=1.
1065
1066wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1067 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1068 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1069 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1070
1071 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1072
1073 Valid WURFL properties are:
1074 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1075
1076 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1077 device.
1078
1079 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1080 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1081
1082 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1083 particular web request.
1084
1085 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1086 used Libwurfl API version.
1087
1088 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1089 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1090 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1091
1092 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1093 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1094
1095 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1096 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1097
1098 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1099
1100 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1101
1102 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1103 with USE_WURFL=1.
1104
1105wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1106 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1107 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1108
1109 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1110 with USE_WURFL=1.
1111
1112wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1113 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1114 thus before the chroot.
1115
1116 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1117 with USE_WURFL=1.
1118
1119wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1120 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1121 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1122 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1123 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1124 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1125 mode is enabled by default.
1126
1127 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1128 with USE_WURFL=1.
1129
1130wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1131 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1132 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1133 - "0" : no cache is used.
1134 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1135 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1136 the highest performing option.
1137
1138 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1139 with USE_WURFL=1.
1140
1141wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1142 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1143 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1144
1145 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1146 with USE_WURFL=1.
1147
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011493.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001150-----------------------
1151
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001152max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1153 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1154 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1155 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1156 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1157 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1158 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1159 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1160 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1161
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001162maxconn <number>
1163 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1164 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1165 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001166 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1167 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1168 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1169 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001170 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1171 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1172 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1173 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1174 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001175
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001176maxconnrate <number>
1177 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1178 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1179 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1180 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1181 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1182 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1183 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1184 fairness.
1185
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001186maxcomprate <number>
1187 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001188 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001189 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1190 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1191 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1192 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1193 default value.
1194
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001195maxcompcpuusage <number>
1196 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1197 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1198 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1199 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1200 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1201 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1202 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1203 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1204
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001205maxpipes <number>
1206 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1207 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1208 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1209 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1210 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1211 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1212
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001213maxsessrate <number>
1214 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1215 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1216 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1217 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1218 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1219 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1220 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1221 fairness.
1222
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001223maxsslconn <number>
1224 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1225 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1226 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1227 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1228 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1229 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1230 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001231 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1232 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1233 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1234 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1235 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1236 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1237 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001238
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001239maxsslrate <number>
1240 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1241 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1242 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1243 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1244 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1245 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1246 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1247 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1248 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1249 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1250
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001251maxzlibmem <number>
1252 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1253 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1254 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001255 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1256 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1257 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1258
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001259noepoll
1260 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1261 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001262 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001263
1264nokqueue
1265 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1266 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1267 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1268
1269nopoll
1270 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1271 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001272 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001273 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001274
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001275nosplice
1276 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1277 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1278 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001279 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001280 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1281 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1282 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1283 "option splice-response".
1284
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001285nogetaddrinfo
1286 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1287 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1288
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001289noreuseport
1290 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1291 command line argument "-dR".
1292
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001293spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001294 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1295 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1296 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1297 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1298 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1299 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001300
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001301ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-seperated list of algorithms>]
1302 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
1303 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
1304 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1305 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1306 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1307 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1308 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
1309 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1310 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-seperated list
1311 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1312 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1313 openssl configuration file uses:
1314 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1315
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001316ssl-mode-async
1317 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001318 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001319 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1320 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1321 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1322 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1323 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001324
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001325tune.buffers.limit <number>
1326 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1327 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1328 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1329 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1330 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1331 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1332 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1333 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1334 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1335 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1336 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1337 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1338 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1339 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1340 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1341
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001342tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1343 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1344 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1345 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1346 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1347
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001348tune.bufsize <number>
1349 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1350 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1351 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1352 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1353 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1354 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1355 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1356 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001357 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1358 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1359 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001360
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001361tune.chksize <number>
1362 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1363 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1364 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1365 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1366 checks whenever possible.
1367
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001368tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1369 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1370 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1371 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1372 this value. The default value is 1.
1373
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001374tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1375 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1376 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1377 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1378 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1379 change it.
1380
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001381tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1382 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
1383 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgement from haproxy. This setting
1384 only affects payload contents (ie: the body of POST requests), not headers.
1385 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1386 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1387 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1388 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1389 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1390
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001391tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1392 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1393 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1394 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1395 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1396 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1397 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1398 recommended not to change this value.
1399
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001400tune.http.cookielen <number>
1401 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1402 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1403 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1404 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1405 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1406 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1407 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1408 to change this value.
1409
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001410tune.http.logurilen <number>
1411 Sets the maximum length of request uri in logs. This prevent to truncate long
1412 requests uris with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
1413 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
1414 'log ... len yyyy' parameter. Your syslog deamon may also need specific
1415 configuration directives too.
1416 The default value is 1024.
1417
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001418tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1419 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1420 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1421 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1422 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1423 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1424 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001425 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1426 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1427 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001428
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001429tune.idletimer <timeout>
1430 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1431 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1432 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1433 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1434 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1435 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1436 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1437 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1438 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1439
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001440tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1441 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001442 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001443 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1444 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1445 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1446 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1447 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1448
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001449tune.lua.maxmem
1450 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1451 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1452 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1453 memory.
1454
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001455tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1456 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001457 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1458 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1459 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001460
1461tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1462 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1463 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1464 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1465 check servers.
1466
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001467tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1468 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1469 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1470 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1471 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1472
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001473tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001474 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1475 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1476 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1477 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1478 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1479 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1480 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1481 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1482 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1483 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001484
1485tune.maxpollevents <number>
1486 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1487 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1488 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1489 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1490 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1491
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001492tune.maxrewrite <number>
1493 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1494 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1495 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1496 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1497 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1498 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1499 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1500 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1501 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1502 bufsize.
1503
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001504tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1505 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1506 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1507 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1508 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1509 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1510 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1511 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1512 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1513 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1514 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1515 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1516 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1517 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1518 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1519 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1520 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1521 setting this parameter to 0.
1522
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001523tune.pipesize <number>
1524 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1525 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1526 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1527 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1528 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1529 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1530
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001531tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1532tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1533 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1534 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1535 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1536 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1537 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1538 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1539 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1540
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001541tune.recv_enough <number>
1542 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1543 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1544 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1545 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1546 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1547
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001548tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1549tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1550 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1551 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1552 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1553 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1554 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1555 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1556 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1557 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1558 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1559 notifying haproxy again.
1560
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001561tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001562 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1563 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1564 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001565 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001566 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1567 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1568 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1569 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1570 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001571 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1572 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001573
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001574tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1575 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1576 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1577 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1578 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1579 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1580 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1581
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001582tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1583 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001584 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001585 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1586 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1587 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1588 being used for too long.
1589
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001590tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1591 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1592 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1593 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1594 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1595 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1596 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1597 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1598 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1599 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1600 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001601 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1602 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001603
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001604tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1605 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1606 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1607 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1608 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1609 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1610 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1611 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001612 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1613 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001614
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001615tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1616 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1617 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1618 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1619 1000 entries.
1620
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001621tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1622 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1623 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1624 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1625
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001626tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001627tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001628tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1629tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1630tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001631 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1632 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1633 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1634 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1635 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1636 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1637 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1638 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001639
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001640 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1641 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1642 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1643 all available space is consumed.
1644 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1645 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1646 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001647
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001648tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1649 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001650 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001651 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1652 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1653 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1654
1655tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1656 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1657 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1658 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1659 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016613.3. Debugging
1662--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001663
1664debug
1665 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1666 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1667 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1668 system startup.
1669
1670quiet
1671 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1672 line argument "-q".
1673
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001674
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016753.4. Userlists
1676--------------
1677It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1678http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1679it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1680
1681userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001682 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001683 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1684
1685group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001686 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001687 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1688 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1689
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001690user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1691 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001692 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1693 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001694 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1695 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1696 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1697 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001698
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001699 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1700 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1701 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1702 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1703 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1704 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1705 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1706 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1707 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001708
1709 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001710 userlist L1
1711 group G1 users tiger,scott
1712 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001713
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001714 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1715 user scott insecure-password elgato
1716 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001717
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001718 userlist L2
1719 group G1
1720 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001721
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001722 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1723 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1724 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001725
1726 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001727
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001728
17293.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001730----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001731It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1732several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1733instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1734values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1735automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1736In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1737using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1738tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1739reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1740Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1741that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1742each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001743
1744peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001745 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001746 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1747
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001748disabled
1749 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1750 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1751 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1752
1753enable
1754 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1755
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001756peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1757 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1758 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1759 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1760 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1761 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1762 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1763
1764 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1765 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1766
1767 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1768 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1769 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1770 across all peers.
1771
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001772 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1773 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001774
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001775 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001776 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001777 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1778 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1779 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001780
1781 backend mybackend
1782 mode tcp
1783 balance roundrobin
1784 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1785 stick on src
1786
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001787 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1788 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001789
1790
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090017913.6. Mailers
1792------------
1793It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1794If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1795in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1796
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001797mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001798 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1799 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1800
1801mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1802 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1803
1804 Example:
1805 mailers mymailers
1806 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1807 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1808
1809 backend mybackend
1810 mode tcp
1811 balance roundrobin
1812
1813 email-alert mailers mymailers
1814 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1815 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1816
1817 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1818 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1819
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001820timeout mail <time>
1821 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1822 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1823 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1824 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1825
1826 Example:
1827 mailers mymailers
1828 timeout mail 20s
1829 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018314. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001832----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001833
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001834Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001835 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001836 - frontend <name>
1837 - backend <name>
1838 - listen <name>
1839
1840A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1841its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1842section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001843section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001844
1845A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1846connections.
1847
1848A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1849to forward incoming connections.
1850
1851A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1852parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1853
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001854All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1855'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1856case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1857
1858Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1859logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1860proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1861However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1862name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1863
1864Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1865and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001866bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001867protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1868modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1869arbitrary criteria.
1870
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001871In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1872a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1873the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1874
1875 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1876 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1877 between responses and new requests.
1878
1879 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1880 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1881 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1882 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1883
1884 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1885 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1886 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1887
1888 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1889 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1890 client-facing connection remains open.
1891
1892 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1893 after the end of the response.
1894
1895The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1896frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1897following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1898weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1899
1900 Backend mode
1901
1902 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1903 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1904 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1905 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1906 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1907 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1908 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1909 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1910 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1911 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1912 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1913
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001914
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019164.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1917--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001919The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1920limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1921they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1922limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001923marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001924option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001925and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1926with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1927specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001928
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001929
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001930 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1931------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1932acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001933appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001934backlog X X X -
1935balance X - X X
1936bind - X X -
1937bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001938block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001939capture cookie - X X -
1940capture request header - X X -
1941capture response header - X X -
1942clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001943compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001944contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1945cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001946declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001947default-server X - X X
1948default_backend X X X -
1949description - X X X
1950disabled X X X X
1951dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001952email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001953email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001954email-alert mailers X X X X
1955email-alert myhostname X X X X
1956email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001957enabled X X X X
1958errorfile X X X X
1959errorloc X X X X
1960errorloc302 X X X X
1961-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1962errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001963force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001964filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001965fullconn X - X X
1966grace X X X X
1967hash-type X - X X
1968http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001969http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001970http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001971http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001972http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001973http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001974http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001975id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001976ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001977load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001978log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001979log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001980log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001981log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001982max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001983maxconn X X X -
1984mode X X X X
1985monitor fail - X X -
1986monitor-net X X X -
1987monitor-uri X X X -
1988option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1989option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1990option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1991option allbackups (*) X - X X
1992option checkcache (*) X - X X
1993option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1994option contstats (*) X X X -
1995option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1996option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1997option forceclose (*) X X X X
1998-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1999option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002000option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002001option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002002option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002003option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002004option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002005option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01002006option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002007option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2008option httpchk X - X X
2009option httpclose (*) X X X X
2010option httplog X X X X
2011option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002012option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002013option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002014option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002015option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2016option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2017option logasap (*) X X X -
2018option mysql-check X - X X
2019option nolinger (*) X X X X
2020option originalto X X X X
2021option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002022option pgsql-check X - X X
2023option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002024option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002025option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002026option smtpchk X - X X
2027option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2028option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2029option splice-request (*) X X X X
2030option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002031option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002032option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2033option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2034-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002035option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002036option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2037option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2038option tcpka X X X X
2039option tcplog X X X X
2040option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002041external-check command X - X X
2042external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002043persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2044rate-limit sessions X X X -
2045redirect - X X X
2046redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2047redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2048reqadd - X X X
2049reqallow - X X X
2050reqdel - X X X
2051reqdeny - X X X
2052reqiallow - X X X
2053reqidel - X X X
2054reqideny - X X X
2055reqipass - X X X
2056reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002057reqitarpit - X X X
2058reqpass - X X X
2059reqrep - X X X
2060-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002061reqtarpit - X X X
2062retries X - X X
2063rspadd - X X X
2064rspdel - X X X
2065rspdeny - X X X
2066rspidel - X X X
2067rspideny - X X X
2068rspirep - X X X
2069rsprep - X X X
2070server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002071server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002072server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002073source X - X X
2074srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002075stats admin - X X X
2076stats auth X X X X
2077stats enable X X X X
2078stats hide-version X X X X
2079stats http-request - X X X
2080stats realm X X X X
2081stats refresh X X X X
2082stats scope X X X X
2083stats show-desc X X X X
2084stats show-legends X X X X
2085stats show-node X X X X
2086stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002087-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2088stick match - - X X
2089stick on - - X X
2090stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002091stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002092stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002093tcp-check connect - - X X
2094tcp-check expect - - X X
2095tcp-check send - - X X
2096tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002097tcp-request connection - X X -
2098tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002099tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002100tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002101tcp-response content - - X X
2102tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002103timeout check X - X X
2104timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002105timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002106timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2107timeout connect X - X X
2108timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2109timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2110timeout http-request X X X X
2111timeout queue X - X X
2112timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002113timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002114timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2115timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002116timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002117transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002118unique-id-format X X X -
2119unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002120use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002121use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002122------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2123 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002124
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021264.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2127---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002128
2129This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2130
2131
2132acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2133 Declare or complete an access list.
2134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2135 no | yes | yes | yes
2136 Example:
2137 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2138 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2139 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002141 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002142
2143
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002144appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2145 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002146 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2148 no | no | yes | yes
2149 Arguments :
2150 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2151 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2152
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002153 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002154 checked in each cookie value.
2155
2156 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2157 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2158 milliseconds.
2159
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002160 request-learn
2161 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2162 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2163 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2164 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2165 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2166 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2167
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002168 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2169 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2170 data following this prefix.
2171
2172 Example :
2173 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2174
2175 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2176 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2177
2178 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2179 2 modes are currently supported :
2180 - path-parameters :
2181 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2182 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2183 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2184 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2185 - query-string :
2186 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2187 query string.
2188
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002189 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2190 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2191 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002192
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002193 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2194 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002195
2196
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002197backlog <conns>
2198 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2200 yes | yes | yes | no
2201 Arguments :
2202 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2203 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002204 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002205
2206 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2207 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2208 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2209 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2210 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2211 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2212 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2213 backlog parameter.
2214
2215 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2216 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2217 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2218
2219 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2220
2221
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002222balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002223balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002224 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2226 yes | no | yes | yes
2227 Arguments :
2228 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2229 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2230 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2231 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2232
2233 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2234 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2235 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2236 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002237 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002238 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002239 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2240 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2241 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2242 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2243 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2244 it, so that you don't worry.
2245
2246 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2247 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2248 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2249 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2250 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2251 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2252 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2253 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002254
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002255 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2256 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2257 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2258 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2259 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2260 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2261 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2262 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2263
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002264 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002265 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002266 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2267 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002268 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002269 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2270 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2271 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2272 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2273 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002274 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2275 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2276 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2277 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2278 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2279 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002280
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002281 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2282 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2283 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2284 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2285 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2286 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2287 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2288 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002289 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002290 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002291 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2292 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2293 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002294
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002295 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2296 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2297 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2298 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2299 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2300 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2301 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2302 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2303 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2304 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2305 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2306 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002308 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002309 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2310 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2311 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2312 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2313 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2314 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2315 URIs start with a leading "/".
2316
2317 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2318 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2319 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2320 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2321
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002322 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002323 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2324
2325 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002326 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2327 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002328 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2329 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2330 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2331 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002332 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002333 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2334 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002335
2336 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2337 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2338 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2339 server will receive the request.
2340
2341 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2342 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2343 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2344 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2345 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002346 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2347 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2348 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002349
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002350 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2351 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2352 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2353 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2354 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002355
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002356 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002357 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2358 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2359 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2360
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002361 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2362 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2363 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2364
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002365 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002366 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002367 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2368 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2369 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2370 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2371 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2372 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002373 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002374 used instead.
2375
2376 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2377 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2378 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2379 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2380
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002381 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2382 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2383 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2384
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002385 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002386
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002387 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002388 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2389 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002390
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002391 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2392 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2393 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002394
2395 Examples :
2396 balance roundrobin
2397 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002398 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002399 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2400 balance hdr(host)
2401 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002402
2403 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2404 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2405
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002406 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002407 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2408 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2409 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2410 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2411
2412 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2413 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2414 defaults to 16 kB.
2415
2416 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2417 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2418
2419 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2420 Round Robin.
2421
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002422 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002423 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2424 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2425 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2426
2427 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2428
2429 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002430 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002431 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2432 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2433 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002434
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002435 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436
2437
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002438bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2439bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002440 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2442 no | yes | yes | no
2443 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002444 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2445 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2446 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2447 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002448 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002449 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2450 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2451 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2452 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2453 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2454 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2455 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002456 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2457 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2458 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2459 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2460 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2461 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2462 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002463 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2464 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2465 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002466 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2467 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2468 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002469
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002470 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2471 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002472 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2473 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2474 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002475 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2476 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2477 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2478 the range.
2479
2480 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2481 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2482 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2483 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2484 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2485 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2486 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002487 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002488 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002489
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002490 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2491 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2492 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2493 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2494 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2495 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2496 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2497 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2498
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002499 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2500 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2501 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2502 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002503
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002504 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2505 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2506 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2507 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2508 in a frontend.
2509
2510 Example :
2511 listen http_proxy
2512 bind :80,:443
2513 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002514 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002515
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002516 listen http_https_proxy
2517 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002518 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002519
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002520 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2521 bind ipv6@:80
2522 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2523 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2524
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002525 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002526 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002527
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002528 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2529 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2530 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2531 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2532 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2533
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002534 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002535 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002536
2537
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002538bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002539 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2541 yes | yes | yes | yes
2542 Arguments :
2543 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2544 may be used to override a default value.
2545
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002546 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002547 option may be combined with other numbers.
2548
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002549 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002550 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2551 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2552 missing from all processes.
2553
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002554 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002555 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002556 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2557 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2558 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2559 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002560
2561 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2562 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2563 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2564 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2565 and 'even' instances.
2566
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002567 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2568 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2569 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2570 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002571
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002572 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2573 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2574
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002575 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2576 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2577 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2578
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002579 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2580 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2581
2582 Example :
2583 listen app_ip1
2584 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002585 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002586
2587 listen app_ip2
2588 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002589 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002590
2591 listen management
2592 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002593 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002594
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002595 listen management
2596 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2597 bind-process 1-4
2598
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002599 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002600
2601
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002602block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2605 no | yes | yes | yes
2606
2607 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2608 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002609 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002610 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002611 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002612 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2613 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2614 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002615
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002616 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2617 "http-request deny" instead.
2618
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002619 Example:
2620 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2621 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2622 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002623 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2624 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2625 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002626
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002627 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2628 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2629 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002630
2631capture cookie <name> len <length>
2632 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2634 no | yes | yes | no
2635 Arguments :
2636 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2637 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2638 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2639 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2640 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2641
2642 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2643 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2644 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2645 right if it exceeds <length>.
2646
2647 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2648 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2649 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2650 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2651
2652 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2653 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2654 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2655
2656 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2657 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2658 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002659 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2660 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2661 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002662
2663 Example:
2664 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2665
2666 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002667 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002668
2669
2670capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002671 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2673 no | yes | yes | no
2674 Arguments :
2675 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002676 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002677 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2678 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2679 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2680
2681 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2682 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2683 it exceeds <length>.
2684
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002685 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002686 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2687 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002688 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2689 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2690 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2691 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002692 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002693 environments to find where the request came from.
2694
2695 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2696 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2697 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2698 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002699
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002700 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2701 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2702 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2703 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2704 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002705
2706 Example:
2707 capture request header Host len 15
2708 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002709 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002711 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002712 about logging.
2713
2714
2715capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002716 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2718 no | yes | yes | no
2719 Arguments :
2720 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002721 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002722 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2723 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2724 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2725
2726 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2727 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2728 it exceeds <length>.
2729
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002730 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002731 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2732 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2733 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002734 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2735 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2736 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2737 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002738
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002739 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2740 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2741 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2742 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2743 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002744
2745 Example:
2746 capture response header Content-length len 9
2747 capture response header Location len 15
2748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002749 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002750 about logging.
2751
2752
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002753clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002754 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2756 yes | yes | yes | no
2757 Arguments :
2758 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2759 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2760 as explained at the top of this document.
2761
2762 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2763 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2764 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2765 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2766 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2767 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2768 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2769 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002770 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002771 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2772 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2773
2774 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2775 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2776 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2777 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2778 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2779 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2780
2781 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2782 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2783
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002784 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2785 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002786
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002787compression algo <algorithm> ...
2788compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002789compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002790 Enable HTTP compression.
2791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2792 yes | yes | yes | yes
2793 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002794 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2795 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2796 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2797
2798 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002799 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2800 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2801 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002802
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002803 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002804 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002805
2806 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2807 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2808 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2809 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2810 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002811 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002812
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002813 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2814 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2815 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2816 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2817 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2818 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2819 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002820 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002821
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002822 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002823 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002824 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2825 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2826 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2827 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2828 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002829
2830 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2831 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2832 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2833 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2834 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002835 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2836 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2837 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2838 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2839 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002840 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2841 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002842
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002843 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002844 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2845 "Accept-Encoding" header
2846 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002847 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002848 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2849 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002850 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2851 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2852 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2853 "multipart"
2854 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2855 header
2856 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2857 and later
2858 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2859 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002860
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002861 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2862 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002863
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002864 Examples :
2865 compression algo gzip
2866 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002867
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002868
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002869contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2872 yes | no | yes | yes
2873 Arguments :
2874 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2875 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2876 as explained at the top of this document.
2877
2878 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002879 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002880 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2882 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2883 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2884 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2885
2886 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2887 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2888 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2889 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2890 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2891 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2892
2893 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2894 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2895 instead.
2896
2897 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2898 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2899
2900
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002901cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002902 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2903 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002904 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002905 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2907 yes | no | yes | yes
2908 Arguments :
2909 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2910 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2911 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2912 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2913 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2914 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2915 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2916 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2917 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2918
2919 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2920 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2921 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2922 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2923 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2924 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002925 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2926 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2927 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2928 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2929 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002930
2931 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002932 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002933
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002934 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002935 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2936 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2937 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2938 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2939 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2940 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2941 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2942 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2943 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2944 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002945
2946 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2947 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2948 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2949 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2950 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2951 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2952 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2953 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2954 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002955 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002956 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2957 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2958 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002959
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002960 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2961 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2962 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002963 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2964 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2965 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2966 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002967 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2968 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2969 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002970
2971 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2972 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2973 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2974 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2975 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2976 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2977 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2978 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2979 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2980
2981 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2982 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2983 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2984 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2985 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2986 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2987 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2988 persistence cookie in the cache.
2989 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2990
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002991 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2992 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2993 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2994 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2995 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2996 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2997 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2998 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2999 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3000 they logout.
3001
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003002 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3003 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3004 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3005 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3006
3007 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3008 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3009 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3010 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3011 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3012 this attribute.
3013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003014 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003015 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003016 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3017 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3018 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3019 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3020 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3021 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003022
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003023 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3024 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3025 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3026 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3027 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3028 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3029 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3030 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
3031 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
3032 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3033 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3034 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3035 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3036 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3037 the site.
3038
3039 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3040 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3041 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3042 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3043 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3044 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3045 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3046 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3047 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3048 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3049 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3050 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3051 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
3052 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
3053 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3054 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3055
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003056 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3057 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3058 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3059 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3060 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3061 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3062
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3064 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3065 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3066 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003067
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003068 Examples :
3069 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3070 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3071 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003072 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003073
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003074 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003075
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003076
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003077declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3078 Declares a capture slot.
3079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3080 no | yes | yes | no
3081 Arguments:
3082 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3083
3084 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3085 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3086 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3087 for use in the response.
3088
3089 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003090 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003091 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3092
3093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003094default-server [param*]
3095 Change default options for a server in a backend
3096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3097 yes | no | yes | yes
3098 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003099 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3100 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3101 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3102 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003103
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003104 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003105 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3106
3107 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003108
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003109
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003110default_backend <backend>
3111 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3113 yes | yes | yes | no
3114 Arguments :
3115 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3116
3117 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3118 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3119 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3120 will catch all undetermined requests.
3121
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003122 Example :
3123
3124 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3125 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3126 default_backend dynamic
3127
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003128 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003130
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003131description <string>
3132 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3134 no | yes | yes | yes
3135 Arguments : string
3136
3137 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3138 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3139 it describes.
3140 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3141
3142
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003143disabled
3144 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3146 yes | yes | yes | yes
3147 Arguments : none
3148
3149 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3150 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3151 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3152 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3153 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3154 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3155 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3156
3157 See also : "enabled"
3158
3159
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003160dispatch <address>:<port>
3161 Set a default server address
3162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3163 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003164 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003165
3166 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3167 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3168 during start-up.
3169
3170 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3171 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3172 possible with normal servers.
3173
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003174 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003175 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3176 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3177 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3178 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3179
3180 See also : "server"
3181
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003182
3183dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3184 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3186 yes | no | yes | yes
3187 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3188
3189 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3190 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3191 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3192 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3193 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3194 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003195
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196enabled
3197 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3199 yes | yes | yes | yes
3200 Arguments : none
3201
3202 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3203 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3204
3205 See also : "disabled"
3206
3207
3208errorfile <code> <file>
3209 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3211 yes | yes | yes | yes
3212 Arguments :
3213 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003214 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3215 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003216
3217 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003218 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003219 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003220 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3221 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003222
3223 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3224 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3225 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3226
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003227 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3228
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003229 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3230 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3231 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3232 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3233
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003234 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3235 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3236 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3237 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3238 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3239 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003241 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3242 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3243 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003244 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003245 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3246
3247 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3248
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003249 Example :
3250 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003251 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003252 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3253 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3254
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003255
3256errorloc <code> <url>
3257errorloc302 <code> <url>
3258 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3260 yes | yes | yes | yes
3261 Arguments :
3262 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003263 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3264 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003265
3266 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3267 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3268 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3269 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3270 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3271
3272 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3273 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3274 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3275
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003276 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3277
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003278 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3279 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3280 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3281 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003282 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003283 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3284 request.
3285
3286 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3287
3288
3289errorloc303 <code> <url>
3290 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3292 yes | yes | yes | yes
3293 Arguments :
3294 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003295 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3296 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003297
3298 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3299 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3300 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3301 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3302 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3303
3304 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3305 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3306 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3307
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003308 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3309
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003310 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3311 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3312 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3313 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003314 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003315
3316 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3317
3318
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003319email-alert from <emailaddr>
3320 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3321 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3322 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3323 yes | yes | yes | yes
3324
3325 Arguments :
3326
3327 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3328
3329 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3330 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3331
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003332 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003333 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3334 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003335
3336
3337email-alert level <level>
3338 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3339 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3340 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3341 yes | yes | yes | yes
3342
3343 Arguments :
3344
3345 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3346 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3347 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3348
3349 By default level is alert
3350
3351 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3352 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3353 for the proxy.
3354
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003355 Alerts are sent when :
3356
3357 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3358 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3359 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3360 is notice or lower
3361 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3362 and a health check status update occurs
3363
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003364 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3365 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003366 section 3.6 about mailers.
3367
3368
3369email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3370 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3371 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3372 yes | yes | yes | yes
3373
3374 Arguments :
3375
3376 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3377
3378 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3379 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3380
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003381 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3382 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003383
3384
3385email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3386 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3387 mailers.
3388 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3389 yes | yes | yes | yes
3390
3391 Arguments :
3392
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003393 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003394
3395 By default the systems hostname is used.
3396
3397 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3398 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3399 for the proxy.
3400
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003401 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3402 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003403
3404
3405email-alert to <emailaddr>
3406 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3407 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3408 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3409 yes | yes | yes | yes
3410
3411 Arguments :
3412
3413 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3414
3415 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3416 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3417
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003418 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003419 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3420
3421
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003422force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3423 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3424 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3425 no | yes | yes | yes
3426
3427 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3428 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3429 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3430 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3431 marked down for maintenance operations.
3432
3433 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3434 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3435 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3436 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3437 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3438 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3439 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3440 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3441 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3442
3443 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3444 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3445 is used.
3446
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003447 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003448 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003449
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003450
3451filter <name> [param*]
3452 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3454 no | yes | yes | yes
3455 Arguments :
3456 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3457 referenced in section 9.
3458
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003459 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003460 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003461 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3462 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003463
3464 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3465 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3466
3467 Example:
3468 listen
3469 bind *:80
3470
3471 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3472 filter compression
3473 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3474
3475 compression algo gzip
3476 compression offload
3477
3478 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3479
3480 See also : section 9.
3481
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003482
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003483fullconn <conns>
3484 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3486 yes | no | yes | yes
3487 Arguments :
3488 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3489 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3490
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003491 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003492 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003493 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003494 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3495 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3496 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3497 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3498 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003499 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003500
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003501 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3502 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003503 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3504 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3505 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003506
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003507 Example :
3508 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3509 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3510 # connections.
3511 backend dynamic
3512 fullconn 10000
3513 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3514 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3515
3516 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3517
3518
3519grace <time>
3520 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003522 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003523 Arguments :
3524 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3525 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3526 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3527
3528 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3529 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003530 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003531 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3532
3533 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3534 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3535 simplify it.
3536
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003537
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003538hash-balance-factor <factor>
3539 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3541 yes | no | no | yes
3542 Arguments :
3543 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3544 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3545 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3546
3547 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3548 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3549 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3550 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3551 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3552 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3553 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3554
3555 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3556 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3557 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3558 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3559 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3560
3561 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3562
3563
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003564hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003565 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3567 yes | no | yes | yes
3568 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003569 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3570 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003571
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003572 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3573 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3574 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3575 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3576 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3577 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3578 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3579 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3580 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3581 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003582
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003583 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3584 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3585 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3586 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3587 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3588 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3589 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3590 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3591 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3592 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3593 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3594 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3595 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003596 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3597 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003598
3599 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3600
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003601 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003602 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3603 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3604 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003605 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3606 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3607 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003608
3609 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3610 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003611 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3612 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3613 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3614 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3615
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003616 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3617 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3618 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3619 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3620 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3621 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3622 parameter.
3623
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003624 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3625 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3626 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3627 used on strings.
3628
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003629 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3630
3631 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3632 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3633 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3634 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3635 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3636 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3637 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3638 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3639 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3640 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3641 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3642 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003643
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003644 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3645 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3646 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003647
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003648 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003649
3650
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003651http-check disable-on-404
3652 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003654 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003655 Arguments : none
3656
3657 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3658 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3659 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3660 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3661 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3662 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3663 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3664 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003665 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3666 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3667 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3668
3669 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3670
3671
3672http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003673 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003675 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003676 Arguments :
3677 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3678 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003679 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003680 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3681 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3682 details on the supported keywords.
3683
3684 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3685 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3686 with the usual backslash ('\').
3687
3688 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3689 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3690 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3691 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3692 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3693
3694 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003695 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003696 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3697 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3698 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3699
3700 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003701 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003702 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3703 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3704 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3705 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3706
3707 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003708 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003709 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3710 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3711 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3712 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3713 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3714 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3715 trace).
3716
3717 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003718 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003719 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3720 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3721 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3722 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3723 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3724 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3725
3726 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3727 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3728 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3729 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3730 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3731 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3732 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3733 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3734
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003735 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3736 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3737 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3738
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003739 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3740 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3741
3742 Examples :
3743 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003744 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003745
3746 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003747 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003748
3749 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003750 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003751
3752 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003753 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003754
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003755 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003756
3757
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003758http-check send-state
3759 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3761 yes | no | yes | yes
3762 Arguments : none
3763
3764 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3765 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3766 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3767 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3768 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3769
3770 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3771 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3772 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3773 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3774 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003775 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3776 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3777 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3778
3779 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3780 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3781 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3782
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003783 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3784 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3785 checked in multiple backends.
3786
3787 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3788 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3789
3790 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3791 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3792 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3793 one fails.
3794
3795 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3796 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3797 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3798
3799 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3800 server's queue.
3801
3802 Example of a header received by the application server :
3803 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3804 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3805
3806 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3807
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003808http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3809 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003810 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003811 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003812 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003813 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3814 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003815 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3816 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003817 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3818 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3819 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003820 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003821 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003822 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003823 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003824 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003825 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003826 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02003827 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003828 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003829 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003830 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3831
3832 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3833 no | yes | yes | yes
3834
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003835 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3836 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3837 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3838 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3839 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003840
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003841 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3842 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3843 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3844
3845 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003846 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3847 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3848 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3849 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003850
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003851 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3852 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3853 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003854 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3855 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003856 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3857 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3858 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3859 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3860 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003861 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003862 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3863 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003864
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003865 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3866 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3867 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3868 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3869 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3870
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003871 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3872 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3873 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003874 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3875 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003876
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003877 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3878 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3879 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3880 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3881 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3882 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3883 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3884 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3885
3886 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3887 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3888 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003889 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3890 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003891
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003892 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3893 <name>.
3894
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003895 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3896 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3897 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3898 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3899 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3900 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3901 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3902 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3903
3904 Example:
3905
3906 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3907
3908 applied to:
3909
3910 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3911
3912 outputs:
3913
3914 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3915
3916 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3917
3918 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3919 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3920 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3921 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3922 header.
3923
3924 Example:
3925
3926 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3927
3928 applied to:
3929
3930 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3931
3932 outputs:
3933
3934 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3935
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003936 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3937 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3938 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3939 it.
3940
3941 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3942 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3943 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3944 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3945 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3946 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3947
3948 Example :
3949 # prepend the host name before the path
3950 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3951
3952 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3953 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3954 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3955 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3956 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3957 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3958 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3959 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3960
3961 Example :
3962 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3963 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3964
3965 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3966 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3967 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3968 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3969 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3970 "set-query".
3971
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003972 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3973 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3974 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3975 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3976 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3977 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3978 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3979 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3980
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003981 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3982 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3983 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3984 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3985 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3986 another equipment.
3987
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003988 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3989 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3990 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3991 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3992 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3993 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3994 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3995 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3996
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003997 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3998 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3999 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4000 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4001 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4002 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4003 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4004 admin privileges.
4005
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004006 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4007 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4008 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4009 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4010 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4011 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4012 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4013 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4014
4015 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4016 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4017 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4018 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4019 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4020 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4021
4022 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4023 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4024 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4025 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4026 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4027 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4028
4029 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4030 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4031 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4032 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4033 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4034 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4035 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4036 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4037 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4038
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004039 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004040 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
4041 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4042 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
4043 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
4044 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
4045 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
4046 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
4047 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4048 request header" for more information.
4049
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004050 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
4051 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
4052 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
4053 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004054 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4055 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004056
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004057 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4058 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
4059 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
4060 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
4061 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
4062 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4063 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4064 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4065 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4066 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4067 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4068 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4069
4070 These actions take one or two arguments :
4071 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4072 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
4073 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
4074 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4075
4076 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4077 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4078 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4079 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4080
4081 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4082 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4083 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4084 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4085 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4086 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4087 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4088 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4089
4090 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4091 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4092 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4093 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4094 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4095
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004096 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4097 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4098 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4099 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4100 continues.
4101
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004102 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4103 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4104 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4105 the actions evaluation continues.
4106
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004107 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4108 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4109 inline.
4110
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004111 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4112 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004113 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004114 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4115 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004116 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004117 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004118 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004119 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4120 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004121 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004122 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004123 and '_'.
4124
4125 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4126 followed by some converters.
4127
4128 Example:
4129
4130 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4131
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004132 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4133 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4134
4135 Example:
4136
4137 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4138
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004139 - set-src <expr> :
4140 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4141 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4142 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4143 source IP for privacy.
4144
4145 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4146 followed by some converters.
4147
4148 Example:
4149
4150 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4151 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4152
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004153 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4154 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004155
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004156 - set-src-port <expr> :
4157 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4158 expression.
4159
4160 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4161 followed by some converters.
4162
4163 Example:
4164
4165 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4166 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4167
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004168 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4169 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4170 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004171
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004172 - set-dst <expr> :
4173 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4174 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4175 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4176 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4177 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4178
4179 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4180 followed by some converters.
4181
4182 Example:
4183
4184 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4185 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4186
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004187 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4188 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4189
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004190 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4191 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4192 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4193 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4194
4195 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4196 followed by some converters.
4197
4198 Example:
4199
4200 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4201 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4202
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004203 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4204 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4205 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4206
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004207 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4208 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4209 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4210 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4211 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4212 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4213 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4214 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4215 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4216 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4217 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4218 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4219 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4220 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4221 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4222 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4223
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004224
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004225 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4226 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4227 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4228
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004229 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4230 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4231 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4232 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4233 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4234 SPOE agent name must be used.
4235
4236 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4237
4238 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4239 configuration.
4240
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004241 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4242
4243 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4244 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004245 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4246 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4247
4248 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4249 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4250 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4251 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004252
4253 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004254 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4255 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4256 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004257
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004258 http-request allow if nagios
4259 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4260 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4261 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004262
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004263 Example:
4264 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004265 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004266
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004267 Example:
4268 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4269 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004270 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004271 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4272 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4273 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4274 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4275 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4276 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4277
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004278 Example:
4279 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4280 acl add path /addacl
4281 acl del path /delacl
4282
4283 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4284
4285 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4286 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4287
4288 Example:
4289 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4290 acl setmap path /setmap
4291 acl delmap path /delmap
4292
4293 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4294
4295 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4296 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4297
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004298 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4299 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004300
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004301http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004302 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004303 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004304 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4305 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004306 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004307 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4308 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4309 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4310 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004311 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004312 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004313 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004314 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004315 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004316 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004317 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004318 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004319 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004320 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004321 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4322
4323 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4324 no | yes | yes | yes
4325
4326 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4327 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4328 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4329 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4330 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4331 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4332
4333 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4334 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4335 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4336 current section.
4337
4338 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4339 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4340 rules are evaluated.
4341
4342 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4343 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4344 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4345 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4346 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4347 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4348 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4349
4350 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4351 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4352 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4353 external users.
4354
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004355 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4356 <name>.
4357
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004358 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4359 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4360 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4361 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4362 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4363 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4364 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4365 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4366
4367 Example:
4368
4369 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4370
4371 applied to:
4372
4373 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4374
4375 outputs:
4376
4377 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4378
4379 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4380
4381 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4382 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4383 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4384 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4385 header.
4386
4387 Example:
4388
4389 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4390
4391 applied to:
4392
4393 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4394
4395 outputs:
4396
4397 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4398
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004399 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004400 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4401 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4402 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004403
4404 Example:
4405
4406 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4407 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004408 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4409 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004410
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004411 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4412 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4413 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4414 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4415 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4416 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4417 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4418 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4419
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004420 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4421 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4422 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4423 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4424 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4425 another equipment.
4426
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004427 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4428 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4429 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4430 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4431 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4432 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4433 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4434 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4435
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004436 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4437 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4438 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4439 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4440 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4441 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4442 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4443 admin privileges.
4444
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004445 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4446 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4447 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4448 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4449 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4450 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4451 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4452 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4453
4454 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4455 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4456 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4457 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4458 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4459 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4460
4461 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4462 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4463 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4464 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4465 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4466 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4467
4468 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4469 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4470 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4471 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4472 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4473 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4474 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4475 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4476 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4477
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004478 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4479 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4480 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4481 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4482 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4483 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4484 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4485 response header" for more information.
4486
4487 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4488 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4489 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4490 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4491 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004492 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4493 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004494
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004495 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4496 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4497 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4498 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4499 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4500 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4501
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004502 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4503 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4504 inline.
4505
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004506 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4507 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004508 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004509 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4510 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004511 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004512 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004513 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004514 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4515 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004516 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004517 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4518 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004519
4520 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4521 followed by some converters.
4522
4523 Example:
4524
4525 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4526
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004527 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4528 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4529
4530 Example:
4531
4532 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4533
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004534 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4535 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4536 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4537 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4538 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4539 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4540 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4541
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004542 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4543 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4544 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4545 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4546 continues.
4547
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004548 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4549 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4550 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4551 the actions evaluation continues.
4552
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004553 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4554 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4555 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4556 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4557 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4558 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4559 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4560 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4561 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4562 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4563 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4564 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4565 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4566 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4567 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4568 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4569
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004570 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4571 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4572 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4573 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4574 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4575 SPOE agent name must be used.
4576
4577 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4578
4579 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4580 configuration.
4581
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004582 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4583
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004584 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004585 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4586 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004587 rules.
4588
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004589 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4590 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4591 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4592 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4593
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004594 Example:
4595 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4596
4597 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4598
4599 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4600 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4601
4602 Example:
4603 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4604
4605 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4606
4607 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4608 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4609
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004610 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4611 ACL usage.
4612
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004613
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004614http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4615 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4616
4617 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4618 yes | no | yes | yes
4619
4620 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4621 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4622 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4623 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4624 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4625 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4626
4627 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4628
4629 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4630 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4631 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4632 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4633 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4634 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4635 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4636 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4637 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4638 not checking any request past the first one.
4639
4640 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4641 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4642 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4643 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4644 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4645 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4646 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4647
4648 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4649 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4650 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4651 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4652 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4653 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4654 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4655 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4656 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4657 downsides of rare connection failures.
4658
4659 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4660 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4661 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4662 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4663 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4664 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4665 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4666 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4667 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4668 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4669 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4670 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4671
4672 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4673 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4674 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4675 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4676
4677 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4678 and are never shared ;
4679
4680 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4681 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4682 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4683 and are never shared ;
4684
4685 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4686 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4687 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4688
4689 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4690 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4691 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4692
4693 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4694
4695
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004696http-send-name-header [<header>]
4697 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4698
4699 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4700 yes | no | yes | yes
4701
4702 Arguments :
4703
4704 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4705
4706 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4707 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4708 is added with the header string proved.
4709
4710 See also : "server"
4711
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004712id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004713 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4715 no | yes | yes | yes
4716 Arguments : none
4717
4718 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4719 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4720 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004721
4722
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004723ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4724 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4725 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4726 no | yes | yes | yes
4727
4728 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4729 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4730 and running).
4731
4732 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4733 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4734 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004735 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004736 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4737
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004738 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4739 "unless" condition is met.
4740
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004741 Example:
4742 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4743 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4744 ignore-persist if url_static
4745
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004746 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4747
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004748load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4749 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4750 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4751 yes | no | yes | yes
4752
4753 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4754 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4755 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4756 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4757 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4758 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4759 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4760 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4761
4762 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4763 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004764 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004765
4766 Arguments:
4767 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4768 named "server-state-file".
4769
4770 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4771 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4772 name is used as a file name.
4773
4774 none don't load any stat for this backend
4775
4776 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004777 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4778 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4779 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4780 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4781 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004782
4783 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4784 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4785
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004786 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004787
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004788 global
4789 stats socket /tmp/socket
4790 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004791
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004792 defaults
4793 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004794
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004795 backend bk
4796 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4797 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004798
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004799
4800 Then one can run :
4801
4802 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4803
4804 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4805
4806 1
4807 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4808 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4809 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4810
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004811 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004812
4813 global
4814 stats socket /tmp/socket
4815 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4816
4817 defaults
4818 load-server-state-from-file local
4819
4820 backend bk
4821 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4822 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4823
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004824
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004825 Then one can run :
4826
4827 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4828
4829 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4830
4831 1
4832 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4833 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4834 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4835
4836 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4837 "show servers state"
4838
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004839
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004840log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004841log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004842no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004843 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4845 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004846
4847 Prefix :
4848 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4849 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4850 prefix does not allow arguments.
4851
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004852 Arguments :
4853 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4854 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4855 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4856 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4857 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4858 parameter.
4859
4860 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4861 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4862
4863 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4864 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4865 standard syslog port).
4866
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004867 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4868 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4869 standard syslog port).
4870
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004871 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4872 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4873 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4874 appropriately writeable).
4875
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004876 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4877 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004878
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004879 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4880 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4881 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4882 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4883 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4884 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4885 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4886 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4887 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4888 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4889 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4890
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004891 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4892
4893 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4894 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4895 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4896
4897 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4898 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4899 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004900 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4901 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4902 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4903 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4904 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004905
4906 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4907
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004908 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4909 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4910 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004911
4912 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4913 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4914 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4915 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4916
4917 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4918 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004919
4920 Example :
4921 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004922 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4923 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004924 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004925
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004926
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004927log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004928 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4929 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4930 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004931
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004932 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4933 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4934 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4935 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4936 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004937
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004938 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4939 "option httplog" directives.
4940
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004941log-format-sd <string>
4942 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4943 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4944 yes | yes | yes | no
4945
4946 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4947 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4948 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4949 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4950 which covers the log format string in depth.
4951
4952 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4953 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4954
4955 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4956 log format to "rfc5424".
4957
4958 Example :
4959 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4960
4961
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004962log-tag <string>
4963 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4965 yes | yes | yes | yes
4966
4967 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4968 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4969 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4970 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4971 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4972 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4973 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4974 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4975 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004976
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004977max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4978 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4979 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4980 yes | no | yes | yes
4981
4982 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4983 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4984 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4985 servers.
4986
4987 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4988 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4989 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4990 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4991 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4992 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4993 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4994 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4995 picking a different server.
4996
4997 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4998 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4999 even if they have to be queued.
5000
5001 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5002 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5003
5004
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005005maxconn <conns>
5006 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5008 yes | yes | yes | no
5009 Arguments :
5010 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5011 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5012 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5013 closes.
5014
5015 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5016 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5017 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5018 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005019 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5020 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5021 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5022 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005023
5024 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5025 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5026 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5027
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005028 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5029
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005030 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5031
5032
5033mode { tcp|http|health }
5034 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5036 yes | yes | yes | yes
5037 Arguments :
5038 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5039 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5040 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5041 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5042
5043 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5044 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5045 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5046 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5047 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5048
5049 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005050 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5051 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5052 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5053 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5054 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5055 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5056 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005057
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005058 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5059 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5060 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005061
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005062 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005063 defaults http_instances
5064 mode http
5065
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005066 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005067
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005068
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005069monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005070 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5072 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005073 Arguments :
5074 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5075 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005076 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005077 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5078 backend and its backup.
5079
5080 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5081 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5082 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5083 servers in a list of backends.
5084
5085 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5086 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5087 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5088 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5089 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5090 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5091 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005092 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5093 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005094
5095 Example:
5096 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005097 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005098 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5099 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5100 monitor-uri /site_alive
5101 monitor fail if site_dead
5102
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005103 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005104
5105
5106monitor-net <source>
5107 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5109 yes | yes | yes | no
5110 Arguments :
5111 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5112 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5113 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5114 followed by a mask.
5115
5116 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5117 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005118 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005119 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5120
5121 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5122 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5123 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5124 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005125 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5126 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5127 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005128
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005129 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5130 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5131 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5132 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5133 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5134 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005135
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005136 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5137 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005138
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005139 Example :
5140 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5141 frontend www
5142 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5143
5144 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5145
5146
5147monitor-uri <uri>
5148 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5150 yes | yes | yes | no
5151 Arguments :
5152 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5153 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5154
5155 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5156 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5157 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5158 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5159 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5160 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5161 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5162 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5163
5164 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5165 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5166 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5167 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5168 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5169 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5170
5171 Example :
5172 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5173 frontend www
5174 mode http
5175 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5176
5177 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5178
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005179
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005180option abortonclose
5181no option abortonclose
5182 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5184 yes | no | yes | yes
5185 Arguments : none
5186
5187 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5188 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5189 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5190 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005191 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005192 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5193 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5194 encountered while delivering the response.
5195
5196 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5197 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5198 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5199 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5200 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5201 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005202 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005203 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005204 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005205 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5206 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5207 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5208
5209 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5210 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5211 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5212 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5213 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5214 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5215 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5216 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005217 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005218
5219 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5220 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5221
5222 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5223
5224
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005225option accept-invalid-http-request
5226no option accept-invalid-http-request
5227 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5229 yes | yes | yes | no
5230 Arguments : none
5231
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005232 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005233 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5234 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5235 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5236 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5237 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5238 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5239 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005240 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5241 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5242 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5243 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5244 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005245 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005246 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5247 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5248 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005249
5250 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5251 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5252 been confirmed.
5253
5254 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5255 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005256 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5257 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005258 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5259
5260 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5261 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5262
5263 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5264 stats socket.
5265
5266
5267option accept-invalid-http-response
5268no option accept-invalid-http-response
5269 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5271 yes | no | yes | yes
5272 Arguments : none
5273
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005274 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005275 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5276 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5277 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5278 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5279 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5280 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5281 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005282 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5283 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5284 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005285
5286 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5287 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5288 been confirmed.
5289
5290 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5291 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5292 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5293 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5294
5295 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5296 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5297
5298 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5299 stats socket.
5300
5301
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005302option allbackups
5303no option allbackups
5304 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5306 yes | no | yes | yes
5307 Arguments : none
5308
5309 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5310 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5311 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5312 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5313 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5314 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5315 order between the backup servers anymore.
5316
5317 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5318 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5319
5320 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5321 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5322
5323
5324option checkcache
5325no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005326 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5328 yes | no | yes | yes
5329 Arguments : none
5330
5331 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5332 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005333 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005334 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5335 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005336 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005337
5338 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005339 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005340 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005341 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5342 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005343 to the client are :
5344 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005345 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005346 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005347 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5348 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5349 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5350 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5351 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5352 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5353 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5354 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5355 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5356 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5357 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5358
5359 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005360 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005361 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005362 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005363 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5364
5365 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5366 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005367 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005368 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5369
5370 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5371 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5372
5373
5374option clitcpka
5375no option clitcpka
5376 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5378 yes | yes | yes | no
5379 Arguments : none
5380
5381 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5382 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5383 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5384 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5385
5386 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5387 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5388 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5389 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5390
5391 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5392 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5393 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5394 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5395 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5396
5397 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5398
5399 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5400 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5401 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5402
5403 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5404 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5405
5406 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5407
5408
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005409option contstats
5410 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5412 yes | yes | yes | no
5413 Arguments : none
5414
5415 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5416 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5417 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5418 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005419 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5420 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5421 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5422 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5423 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005424
5425
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005426option dontlog-normal
5427no option dontlog-normal
5428 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5430 yes | yes | yes | no
5431 Arguments : none
5432
5433 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5434 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5435 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5436 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5437 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5438 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5439 logged.
5440
5441 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5442 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5443 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005445 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005446 logging.
5447
5448
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005449option dontlognull
5450no option dontlognull
5451 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5452 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5453 yes | yes | yes | no
5454 Arguments : none
5455
5456 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5457 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5458 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5459 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5460 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5461 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005462 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5463 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5464 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005465
5466 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5467 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5468 would not be logged.
5469
5470 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5471 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5472
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005473 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5474 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005475
5476
5477option forceclose
5478no option forceclose
5479 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005481 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005482 Arguments : none
5483
5484 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5485 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5486 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5487 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5488 global session times in the logs.
5489
5490 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005491 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005492 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005493
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005494 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5495 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5496 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5497
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005498 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5499 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005500
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005501 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5502 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5503
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005504 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005505
5506
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005507option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005508 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5510 yes | yes | yes | yes
5511 Arguments :
5512 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5513 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005514 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005515 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005516
5517 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5518 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5519 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5520 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5521 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5522 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5523 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005524 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5525 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5526 possible that the client has already brought one.
5527
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005528 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005529 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005530 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5531 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005532 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5533 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005534
5535 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5536 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5537 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5538 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5539 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5540 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5541 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5542
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005543 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5544 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5545 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5546 are under the control of the end-user.
5547
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005548 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005549 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5550 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005551 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5552 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5553 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005554
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005555 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005556 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5557 frontend www
5558 mode http
5559 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5560
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005561 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5562 backend www
5563 mode http
5564 option forwardfor header X-Client
5565
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005566 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005567 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005568
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005569
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005570option http-buffer-request
5571no option http-buffer-request
5572 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5574 yes | yes | yes | yes
5575 Arguments : none
5576
5577 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5578 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5579 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5580 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5581 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5582 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5583 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5584 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005585 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005586 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5587 default.
5588
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005589 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005590
5591
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005592option http-ignore-probes
5593no option http-ignore-probes
5594 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5596 yes | yes | yes | no
5597 Arguments : none
5598
5599 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5600 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5601 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5602 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5603 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5604 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5605 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5606 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5607 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5608 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5609 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5610 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5611
5612 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5613 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5614 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5615 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5616 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5617 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5618 are often the only way to detect them.
5619
5620 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5621 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5622
5623 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5624
5625
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005626option http-keep-alive
5627no option http-keep-alive
5628 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5630 yes | yes | yes | yes
5631 Arguments : none
5632
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005633 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5634 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5635 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5636 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5637 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5638 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5639 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5640
5641 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5642 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005643 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5644 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5645 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5646 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5647 situations where this option may be useful :
5648
5649 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5650 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5651
5652 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5653 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5654
5655 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5656 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5657 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5658 request.
5659
5660 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5661 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005662 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5663 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5664 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005665
5666 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5667 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5668
5669 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5670 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5671 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5672 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5673 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5674 not set.
5675
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005676 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5677 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005678 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005679 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005680
5681 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005682 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5683 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005684
5685
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005686option http-no-delay
5687no option http-no-delay
5688 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5690 yes | yes | yes | yes
5691 Arguments : none
5692
5693 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5694 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5695 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5696 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5697 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5698 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5699 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5700 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5701 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5702 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5703 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5704 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5705 affected.
5706
5707 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5708 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5709 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5710 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5711 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5712 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5713 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5714 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5715 latency environments.
5716
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005717 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5718
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005719
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005720option http-pretend-keepalive
5721no option http-pretend-keepalive
5722 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5724 yes | yes | yes | yes
5725 Arguments : none
5726
5727 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5728 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5729 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5730 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5731 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5732 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5733 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5734 consider the response complete.
5735
5736 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5737 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5738 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5739 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5740 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5741 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5742
5743 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5744 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5745 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5746 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5747 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5748 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5749 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5750
5751 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5752 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005753 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005754 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5755 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005756
5757 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5758 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5759
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005760 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5761 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005762
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005763
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005764option http-server-close
5765no option http-server-close
5766 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5768 yes | yes | yes | yes
5769 Arguments : none
5770
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005771 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5772 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5773 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5774 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5775 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5776 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5777 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5778 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5779 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5780 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5781 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005782 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005783 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5784 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5785 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5786 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005787
5788 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5789 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5790 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5791 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005792 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5793 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005794
5795 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5796 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005797 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5798 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005799 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5800 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005801
5802 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5803 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5804
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005805 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005806 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5807 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005808
5809
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005810option http-tunnel
5811no option http-tunnel
5812 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5814 yes | yes | yes | yes
5815 Arguments : none
5816
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005817 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5818 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5819 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5820 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5821 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5822 "option http-tunnel".
5823
5824 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005825 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005826 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5827 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5828 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5829 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5830 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5831 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5832 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005833
5834 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5835 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5836
5837 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5838 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5839 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5840
5841
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005842option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005843no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005844 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5846 yes | yes | yes | no
5847 Arguments : none
5848
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005849 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005850 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5851 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5852 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5853 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5854 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5855 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5856
5857 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5858 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005859 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5860 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5861 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005862
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005863 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5864 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5865 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5866 front of an existing proxy.
5867
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005868 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5869
5870 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5871 http-server-close".
5872
5873
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005874option httpchk
5875option httpchk <uri>
5876option httpchk <method> <uri>
5877option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5878 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5880 yes | no | yes | yes
5881 Arguments :
5882 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5883 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5884 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5885 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5886 ones.
5887
5888 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5889 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5890 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5891
5892 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5893 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5894 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5895 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5896 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5897
5898 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5899 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5900 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5901 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5902 the lack of any response.
5903
5904 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5905
5906 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5907 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5908 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5909
5910 Examples :
5911 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5912 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5913 backend https_relay
5914 mode tcp
5915 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5916 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5917
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005918 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5919 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5920 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005921
5922
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005923option httpclose
5924no option httpclose
5925 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5927 yes | yes | yes | yes
5928 Arguments : none
5929
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005930 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5931 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5932 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5933 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005934 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005935 "option http-tunnel".
5936
5937 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5938 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5939 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5940 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5941 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5942 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5943 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5944 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005945
5946 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005947 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005948 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5949 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5950 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5951 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5952 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005953
5954 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5955 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005956 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5957 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005958 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5959 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005960
5961 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5962 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5963
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005964 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5965 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005966
5967
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005968option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005969 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5971 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005972 Arguments :
5973 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5974 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5975 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5976 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5977 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005978
5979 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5980 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5981 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5982 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5983 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5984 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5985 ports.
5986
5987 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5988
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005989 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5990 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005991
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005992 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
5993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005994 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005995
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005996
5997option http_proxy
5998no option http_proxy
5999 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6001 yes | yes | yes | yes
6002 Arguments : none
6003
6004 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6005 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6006 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6007 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6008 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6009
6010 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6011 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006012 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6013 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006014
6015 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6016 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6017
6018 Example :
6019 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6020 backend direct_forward
6021 option httpclose
6022 option http_proxy
6023
6024 See also : "option httpclose"
6025
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006026
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006027option independent-streams
6028no option independent-streams
6029 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6031 yes | yes | yes | yes
6032 Arguments : none
6033
6034 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6035 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6036 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6037 receive data or not.
6038
6039 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
6040 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6041 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6042 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6043 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6044 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6045 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6046 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6047 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6048 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6049 socket buffers.
6050
6051 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6052 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6053 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6054 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6055 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6056
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006057 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006058 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6059 deprecated.
6060
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006061 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006062
6063
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006064option ldap-check
6065 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6067 yes | no | yes | yes
6068 Arguments : none
6069
6070 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6071 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6072 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6073 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6074
6075 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6076 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6077
6078 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6079 configure it.
6080
6081 Example :
6082 option ldap-check
6083
6084 See also : "option httpchk"
6085
6086
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006087option external-check
6088 Use external processes for server health checks
6089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6090 yes | no | yes | yes
6091
6092 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6093 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6094 command".
6095
6096 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6097
6098 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6099
6100
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006101option log-health-checks
6102no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006103 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6105 yes | no | yes | yes
6106 Arguments : none
6107
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006108 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6109 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6110 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006111
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006112 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6113 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6114 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6115 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6116 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6117
6118 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
6119 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006120
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006121 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6122 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6123 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006124
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006125
6126option log-separate-errors
6127no option log-separate-errors
6128 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6130 yes | yes | yes | no
6131 Arguments : none
6132
6133 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6134 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6135 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6136 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6137 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6138 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6139 provides very important information.
6140
6141 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6142 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6143 error logs.
6144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006145 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006146 logging.
6147
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006148
6149option logasap
6150no option logasap
6151 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6153 yes | yes | yes | no
6154 Arguments : none
6155
6156 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6157 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6158 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6159 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6160 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6161 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6162 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006163 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006164 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6165 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6166
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006167 Examples :
6168 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6169 mode http
6170 option httplog
6171 option logasap
6172 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6173
6174 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6175 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6176 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6177 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006179 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006180 logging.
6181
6182
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006183option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006184 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6186 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006187 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006188 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6189 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006190 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006191
6192 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6193 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6194 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6195 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6196 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6197 in the MySQL table, like this :
6198
6199 USE mysql;
6200 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6201 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6202
6203 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6204 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6205 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6206 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6207 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6208 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6209 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6210 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6211 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6212
6213 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6214 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006215
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006216 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006217
6218 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6219 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6220 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6221 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006222 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6223 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006224
6225 See also: "option httpchk"
6226
6227
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006228option nolinger
6229no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006230 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006231 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6232 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006233 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006234
6235 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6236 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6237 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6238 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6239 connections.
6240
6241 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6242 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6243 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6244 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6245 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6246 this too.
6247
6248 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6249 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6250 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6251
6252 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6253 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6254 for servers.
6255
6256 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6257 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6258
6259
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006260option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6261 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6263 yes | yes | yes | yes
6264 Arguments :
6265 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6266 matching <network>
6267 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6268 header name.
6269
6270 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6271 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6272 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6273 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6274 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6275 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6276 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6277 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6278 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6279 possible that the client has already brought one.
6280
6281 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6282 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6283 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6284 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6285 header and requires different one.
6286
6287 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6288 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6289 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6290 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6291 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6292 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6293 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6294
6295 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6296 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6297 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6298 both are defined.
6299
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006300 Examples :
6301 # Original Destination address
6302 frontend www
6303 mode http
6304 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6305
6306 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6307 backend www
6308 mode http
6309 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6310
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006311 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6312 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006313
6314
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006315option persist
6316no option persist
6317 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6318 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6319 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006320 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006321
6322 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6323 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6324 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6325 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6326 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6327 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6328 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6329 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6330 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6331 redirected to another valid server.
6332
6333 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6334 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6335
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006336 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006337
6338
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006339option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6340 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6342 yes | no | yes | yes
6343 Arguments :
6344 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6345 PostgreSQL server.
6346
6347 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6348 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6349 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6350 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6351
6352 See also: "option httpchk"
6353
6354
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006355option prefer-last-server
6356no option prefer-last-server
6357 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6358 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6359 yes | no | yes | yes
6360 Arguments : none
6361
6362 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6363 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6364 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6365 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6366 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6367 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6368 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6369 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6370 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006371 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6372 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6373 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6374 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6375 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6376 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6377 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006378
6379 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6380 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6381
6382 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6383
6384
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006385option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006386option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006387no option redispatch
6388 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6389 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6390 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006391 Arguments :
6392 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6393 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6394 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6395 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6396 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6397 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6398 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6399 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6400 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006402
6403 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6404 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6405 be able to access the service anymore.
6406
6407 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6408 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6409
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006410 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006411 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6412 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006413
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006414 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6415 "redisp" keywords.
6416
6417 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6418 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6419
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006420 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006421
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006422
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006423option redis-check
6424 Use redis health checks for server testing
6425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6426 yes | no | yes | yes
6427 Arguments : none
6428
6429 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6430 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6431 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6432 find the "+PONG" response message.
6433
6434 Example :
6435 option redis-check
6436
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006437 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006438
6439
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006440option smtpchk
6441option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6442 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6444 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006445 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006446 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6447 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6448 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6449
6450 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6451 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6452 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6453
6454 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6455 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6456 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6457 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6458 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6459 dead server.
6460
6461 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6462 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6463 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6464 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6465
6466 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6467 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6468 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6469 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006470 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006471
6472 Example :
6473 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6474
6475 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6476
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006477
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006478option socket-stats
6479no option socket-stats
6480
6481 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6483 yes | yes | yes | no
6484
6485 Arguments : none
6486
6487
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006488option splice-auto
6489no option splice-auto
6490 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6492 yes | yes | yes | yes
6493 Arguments : none
6494
6495 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6496 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6497 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6498 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006499 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006500 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6501 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6502 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6503 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6504
6505 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6506 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6507 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6508 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6509 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6510 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6511 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6512 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6513 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6514 keyword.
6515
6516 Example :
6517 option splice-auto
6518
6519 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6520 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6521
6522 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6523 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6524
6525
6526option splice-request
6527no option splice-request
6528 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6530 yes | yes | yes | yes
6531 Arguments : none
6532
6533 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006534 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006535 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6536 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6537 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6538 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6539
6540 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6541
6542 Example :
6543 option splice-request
6544
6545 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6546 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6547
6548 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6549 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6550
6551
6552option splice-response
6553no option splice-response
6554 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6556 yes | yes | yes | yes
6557 Arguments : none
6558
6559 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006560 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006561 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6562 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6563 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6564 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6565
6566 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6567
6568 Example :
6569 option splice-response
6570
6571 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6572 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6573
6574 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6575 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6576
6577
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006578option spop-check
6579 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6581 no | no | no | yes
6582 Arguments : none
6583
6584 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6585 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6586 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6587 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6588
6589 Example :
6590 option spop-check
6591
6592 See also : "option httpchk"
6593
6594
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006595option srvtcpka
6596no option srvtcpka
6597 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6599 yes | no | yes | yes
6600 Arguments : none
6601
6602 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6603 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6604 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6605 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6606
6607 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6608 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6609 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6610 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6611
6612 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6613 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6614 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6615 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6616 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6617
6618 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6619
6620 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6621 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6622 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6623
6624 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6625 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6626
6627 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6628
6629
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006630option ssl-hello-chk
6631 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6633 yes | no | yes | yes
6634 Arguments : none
6635
6636 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6637 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6638 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6639 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6640 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6641 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6642 hello message.
6643
6644 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6645 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6646 messages, which is appreciable.
6647
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006648 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6649 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6650 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006651
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006652 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6653
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006654
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006655option tcp-check
6656 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6657 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6658 yes | no | yes | yes
6659
6660 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6661 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6662
6663 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6664 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6665 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6666
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006667 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006668 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6669 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6670 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6671 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6672 only.
6673
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006674 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006675 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6676 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6677 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6678 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6679
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006680 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006681 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6682 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006683 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006684 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6685 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6686 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6687 the respective protocols.
6688 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6689 analysed.
6690
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006691 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6692 script.
6693
6694 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6695 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6696 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6697 The "comment" is of course optional.
6698
6699
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006700 Examples :
6701 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6702 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006703 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006704
6705 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6706 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006707 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006708
6709 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6710 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006711 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006712 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006713 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006714 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006715 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006716 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006717 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6718 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006719 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006720 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6721 tcp-check expect string +OK
6722
6723 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6724 (send many headers before analyzing)
6725 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006726 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006727 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6728 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6729 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6730 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006731 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006732
6733
6734 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6735
6736
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006737option tcp-smart-accept
6738no option tcp-smart-accept
6739 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6741 yes | yes | yes | no
6742 Arguments : none
6743
6744 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6745 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6746 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6747 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6748 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6749 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6750
6751 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6752 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6753 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6754 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6755
6756 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6757 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6758 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6759 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6760
6761 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6762 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6763 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6764
6765 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6766 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6767 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6768
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006769 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6770
6771
6772option tcp-smart-connect
6773no option tcp-smart-connect
6774 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6776 yes | no | yes | yes
6777 Arguments : none
6778
6779 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6780 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6781 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6782 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6783 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6784
6785 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6786 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6787 complex.
6788
6789 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6790 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6791 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6792
6793 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6794 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6795
6796 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6797
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006798
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006799option tcpka
6800 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6802 yes | yes | yes | yes
6803 Arguments : none
6804
6805 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6806 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6807 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6808 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6809
6810 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6811 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6812 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6813 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6814
6815 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6816 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6817 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6818 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6819 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6820
6821 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6822
6823 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6824 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6825 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6826 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6827 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6828 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6829 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6830 backends.
6831
6832 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6833
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006834
6835option tcplog
6836 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6838 yes | yes | yes | yes
6839 Arguments : none
6840
6841 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6842 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6843 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6844 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6845 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6846 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6847 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6848 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6849
6850 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6851
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006852 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006854 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006855
6856
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006857option transparent
6858no option transparent
6859 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006861 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006862 Arguments : none
6863
6864 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6865 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6866 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6867 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6868 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6869 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6870 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6871 appropriate server.
6872
6873 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6874 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6875
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006876 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006877 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006878
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006879
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006880external-check command <command>
6881 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6883 yes | no | yes | yes
6884
6885 Arguments :
6886 <command> is the external command to run
6887
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006888 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6889
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006890 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006891
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006892 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6893 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6894 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6895 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6896 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6897 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006898
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006899 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6900
6901 Environment variables :
6902 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6903 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6904
6905 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6906
6907 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6908
6909 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6910 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6911 for a UNIX socket).
6912
6913 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6914
6915 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6916
6917 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6918
6919 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6920
6921 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6922
6923 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6924 socket).
6925
6926 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6927 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6928
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006929 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6930 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6931 failed.
6932
6933 Example :
6934 external-check command /bin/true
6935
6936 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6937
6938
6939external-check path <path>
6940 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6942 yes | no | yes | yes
6943
6944 Arguments :
6945 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6946
6947 The default path is "".
6948
6949 Example :
6950 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6951
6952 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6953 "external-check command"
6954
6955
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006956persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006957persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006958 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6960 yes | no | yes | yes
6961 Arguments :
6962 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006963 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6964 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006965
6966 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6967 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6968 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6969 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6970 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6971 forwarded to this server.
6972
6973 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6974 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6975 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006976 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006977 a single "listen" section.
6978
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006979 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6980 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6981 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6982
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006983 Example :
6984 listen tse-farm
6985 bind :3389
6986 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6987 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6988 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6989 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6990 persist rdp-cookie
6991 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006992 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006993 balance rdp-cookie
6994 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6995 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6996
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006997 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6998 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006999
7000
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007001rate-limit sessions <rate>
7002 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7004 yes | yes | yes | no
7005 Arguments :
7006 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7007 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7008
7009 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7010 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7011 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7012 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7013 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7014 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7015
7016 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7017 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7018 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7019 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7020
7021 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7022 listen smtp
7023 mode tcp
7024 bind :25
7025 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007026 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007027
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007028 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7029 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7030 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007031
7032 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7033
7034
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007035redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7036redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7037redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007038 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7040 no | yes | yes | yes
7041
7042 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007043 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007044
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007045 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007046 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007047 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7048 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7049 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007050
7051 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7052 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7053 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7054 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7055 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007056 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7057 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7058 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7059 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007060
7061 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7062 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7063 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7064 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7065 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7066 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007067 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007068 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007069 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7070 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7071 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007072
7073 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007074 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7075 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7076 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007077 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007078 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7079 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7080 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7081 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007082
7083 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
7084 expected behaviour of a redirection :
7085
7086 - "drop-query"
7087 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7088 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7089 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7090 with a location-type redirect.
7091
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007092 - "append-slash"
7093 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7094 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7095 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7096 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7097
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007098 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7099 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7100 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7101 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7102 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7103 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7104 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7105
7106 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7107 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7108 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7109 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7110 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7111 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7112 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007113
7114 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7115 acl clear dst_port 80
7116 acl secure dst_port 8080
7117 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007118 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007119 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007120 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7121
7122 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007123 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7124 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7125 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007126 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007127
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007128 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7129 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7130 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7131
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007132 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007133 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007134
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007135 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007136 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7137 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7138 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007140 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007141
7142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007143redisp (deprecated)
7144redispatch (deprecated)
7145 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7146 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7147 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007148 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007149
7150 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7151 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7152 be able to access the service anymore.
7153
7154 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7155 redistribute them to a working server.
7156
7157 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7158 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7159 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007160
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007161 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7162 "option redispatch" instead.
7163
7164 See also : "option redispatch"
7165
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007166
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007167reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007168 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7170 no | yes | yes | yes
7171 Arguments :
7172 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7173 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007174 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007175
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007176 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7177 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7178
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007179 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7180 the last header of an HTTP request.
7181
7182 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7183 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7184 responses.
7185
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007186 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7187 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7188 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7189
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007190 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7191 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007192
7193
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007194reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7195reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007196 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7198 no | yes | yes | yes
7199 Arguments :
7200 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7201 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7202 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7203 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7204 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7205 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7206 ignores case.
7207
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007208 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7209 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7210
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007211 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7212 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7213 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7214 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007215 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007216
7217 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7218 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7219
7220 Example :
7221 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7222 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7223 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7224
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007225 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7226 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007227
7228
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007229reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7230reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007231 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7233 no | yes | yes | yes
7234 Arguments :
7235 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7236 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7237 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7238 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7239 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7240 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7241
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007242 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7243 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7244
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007245 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7246 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7247 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7248 next servers.
7249
7250 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7251 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7252 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7253
7254 Example :
7255 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7256 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7257 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7258
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007259 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7260 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007261
7262
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007263reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7264reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007265 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7267 no | yes | yes | yes
7268 Arguments :
7269 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7270 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7271 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7272 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7273 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7274 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7275 case.
7276
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007277 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7278 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7279
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007280 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7281 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7282 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7283 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007284 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007285
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007286 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007287 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007288 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007289
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007290 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7291 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7292
7293 Example :
7294 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7295 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7296 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7297
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007298 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7299 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007300
7301
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007302reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7303reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007304 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7306 no | yes | yes | yes
7307 Arguments :
7308 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7309 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7310 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7311 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7312 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7313 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7314 case.
7315
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007316 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7317 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7318
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007319 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7320 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7321 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7322 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7323
7324 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7325 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7326
7327 Example :
7328 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7329 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7330 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7331 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7332
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007333 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7334 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007335
7336
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007337reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7338reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007339 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7341 no | yes | yes | yes
7342 Arguments :
7343 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7344 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7345 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7346 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7347 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7348 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7349
7350 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7351 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7352 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7353 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007354 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007355
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007356 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7357 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7358
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007359 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7360 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7361 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7362
7363 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7364 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7365 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7366 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7367 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7368
7369 Example :
7370 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007371 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007372 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7373 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7374
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007375 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7376 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007377
7378
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007379reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7380reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007381 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7383 no | yes | yes | yes
7384 Arguments :
7385 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7386 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7387 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7388 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7389 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7390 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7391 ignores case.
7392
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007393 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7394 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7395
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007396 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7397 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007398 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7399 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7400 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007401 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7402 not set.
7403
7404 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7405 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7406 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7407 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7408 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7409
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007410 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007411 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7412 # block all others.
7413 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7414 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7415
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007416 # block bad guys
7417 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7418 reqitarpit . if badguys
7419
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007420 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7421 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007422
7423
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007424retries <value>
7425 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7426 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7427 yes | no | yes | yes
7428 Arguments :
7429 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7430 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7431 default value is 3.
7432
7433 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7434 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7435 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7436
7437 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007438 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7439 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007440
7441 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7442 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7443
7444 See also : "option redispatch"
7445
7446
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007447rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007448 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7450 no | yes | yes | yes
7451 Arguments :
7452 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7453 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007454 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007455
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007456 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7457 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7458
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007459 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7460 the last header of an HTTP response.
7461
7462 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7463 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7464 responses.
7465
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007466 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7467 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007468
7469
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007470rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7471rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007472 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7474 no | yes | yes | yes
7475 Arguments :
7476 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7477 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7478 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7479 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7480 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7481 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7482 ignores case.
7483
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007484 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7485 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7486
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007487 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7488 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007489 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007490 client.
7491
7492 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7493 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7494 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7495
7496 Example :
7497 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007498 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007499
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007500 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7501 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007502
7503
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007504rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7505rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007506 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7508 no | yes | yes | yes
7509 Arguments :
7510 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7511 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7512 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7513 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7514 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7515 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7516 ignores case.
7517
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007518 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7519 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7520
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007521 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7522 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7523 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7524 case-sensitive.
7525
7526 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007527 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7528 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7529 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007530
7531 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7532 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7533
7534 Example :
7535 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7536 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7537
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007538 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7539 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007540
7541
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007542rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7543rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007544 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7546 no | yes | yes | yes
7547 Arguments :
7548 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7549 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7550 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7551 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7552 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7553 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7554 ignores case.
7555
7556 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7557 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7558 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7559 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007560 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007561
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007562 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7563 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7564
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007565 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7566 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7567 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7568
7569 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7570 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7571 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7572 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7573 are not case-sensitive.
7574
7575 Example :
7576 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7577 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7578
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007579 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7580 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007581
7582
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007583server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007584 Declare a server in a backend
7585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7586 no | no | yes | yes
7587 Arguments :
7588 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007589 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007590 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007591
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007592 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7593 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7594 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7595 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007596 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7597 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7598 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7599 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7600 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007601 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7602 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7603 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7604 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7605 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7606 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7607 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007608 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007609 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7610 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007611 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7612 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007613
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007614 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007615 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7616 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7617 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7618 adding this value to the client's port.
7619
7620 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7621 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007622 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007623
7624 Examples :
7625 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7626 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007627 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007628 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7629 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7630 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007631
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007632 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7633 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7634 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7635 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7636 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7637
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007638 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7639 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007640
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007641server-state-file-name [<file>]
7642 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7643 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7644 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7645 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7646 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7647 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7648
7649 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7650 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7651
7652 global
7653 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7654
7655 backend bk
7656 load-server-state-from-file
7657
7658 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7659 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007660
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007661server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7662 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7663 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7665 no | no | yes | yes
7666
7667 Arguments:
7668 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7669
7670 <num | range>
7671 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7672 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7673 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7674 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7675
7676 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7677
7678 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7679
7680 <params*>
7681 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7682 keyword.
7683
7684 Examples:
7685 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7686 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7687 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7688
7689 # or
7690 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7691
7692 # would be equivalent to:
7693 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7694 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7695 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7696
7697
7698
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007699source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007700source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007701source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007702 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7704 yes | no | yes | yes
7705 Arguments :
7706 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7707 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007708
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007709 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007710 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7711 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7712 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7713 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7714 supported prefixes are :
7715 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7716 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7717 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007718 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007719 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7720 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007721
7722 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7723 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007724 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7725 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7726 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007727
7728 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7729 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7730 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7731 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7732 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7733 <addr>.
7734
7735 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7736 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7737 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7738 port.
7739
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007740 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7741 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7742 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7743 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007744 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007745 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7746 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7747 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7748 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7749 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7750 HTTP header.
7751
7752 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7753 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007754 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007755 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7756 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7757 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7758 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7759 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7760 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7761 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7762
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007763 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7764 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7765 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7766 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7767 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7768 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7769
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007770 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7771 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7772 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7773 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7774
7775 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7776 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7777 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7778 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7779 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7780 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7781
7782 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7783 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7784 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7785 there are two methods :
7786
7787 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7788 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7789 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7790 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7791 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7792 of the client ranges may be used.
7793
7794 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7795 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7796 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7797 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7798 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7799 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7800 same session.
7801
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007802 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7803 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7804 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007805 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007806
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007807 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7808
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007809 Examples :
7810 backend private
7811 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7812 source 192.168.1.200
7813
7814 backend transparent_ssl1
7815 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7816 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7817
7818 backend transparent_ssl2
7819 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7820 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7821 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7822
7823 backend transparent_ssl3
7824 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7825 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7826 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7827
7828 backend transparent_smtp
7829 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7830 # with Tproxy version 4.
7831 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7832
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007833 backend transparent_http
7834 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7835 # proxy.
7836 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007838 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007839 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7840
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007841
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007842srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7843 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7845 yes | no | yes | yes
7846 Arguments :
7847 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7848 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7849 as explained at the top of this document.
7850
7851 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7852 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7853 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7854 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7855 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7856 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7857 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7858
7859 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7860 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7861 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7862 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7863 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007864 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007865 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007866 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007867
7868 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7869 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7870 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7871 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7872 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7873 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7874
7875 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7876 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7877
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007878 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7879 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007880
7881
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007882stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7883 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007885 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007886
7887 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7888 matched.
7889
7890 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7891 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7892
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007893 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7894 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7895 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7896
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007897 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7898 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7899 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7900 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007901
7902 Example :
7903 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7904 backend stats_localhost
7905 stats enable
7906 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7907
7908 Example :
7909 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7910 backend stats_auth
7911 stats enable
7912 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7913 stats admin if TRUE
7914
7915 Example :
7916 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7917 userlist stats-auth
7918 group admin users admin
7919 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7920 group readonly users haproxy
7921 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7922
7923 backend stats_auth
7924 stats enable
7925 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7926 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7927 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7928 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7929
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007930 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7931 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7932 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007933
7934
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007935stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7936 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007938 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007939 Arguments :
7940 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7941
7942 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7943
7944 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7945 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7946 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7947 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7948 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7949 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7950
7951 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7952 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7953 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007954 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007955
7956 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7957 report using "stats scope".
7958
7959 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7960 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7961 unobvious parameters.
7962
7963 Example :
7964 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7965 backend public_www
7966 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7967 stats enable
7968 stats hide-version
7969 stats scope .
7970 stats uri /admin?stats
7971 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7972 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7973 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7974
7975 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7976 backend private_monitoring
7977 stats enable
7978 stats uri /admin?stats
7979 stats refresh 5s
7980
7981 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7982
7983
7984stats enable
7985 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007987 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007988 Arguments : none
7989
7990 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7991 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7992 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7993 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7994 - stats auth : no authentication
7995 - stats scope : no restriction
7996
7997 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7998 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7999 unobvious parameters.
8000
8001 Example :
8002 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8003 backend public_www
8004 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8005 stats enable
8006 stats hide-version
8007 stats scope .
8008 stats uri /admin?stats
8009 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8010 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8011 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8012
8013 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8014 backend private_monitoring
8015 stats enable
8016 stats uri /admin?stats
8017 stats refresh 5s
8018
8019 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8020
8021
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008022stats hide-version
8023 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008025 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008026 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008027
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008028 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8029 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8030 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8031 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8032 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8033 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008035 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8036 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8037 unobvious parameters.
8038
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008039 Example :
8040 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8041 backend public_www
8042 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008043 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008044 stats hide-version
8045 stats scope .
8046 stats uri /admin?stats
8047 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8048 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8049 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008050
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008051 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8052 backend private_monitoring
8053 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008054 stats uri /admin?stats
8055 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008056
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008057 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008058
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008059
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008060stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8061 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8062 Access control for statistics
8063
8064 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8065 no | no | yes | yes
8066
8067 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8068 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8069 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8070 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8071 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8072 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8073
8074 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8075 instance.
8076
8077 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8078 about ACL usage.
8079
8080
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008081stats realm <realm>
8082 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008084 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008085 Arguments :
8086 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8087 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8088 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8089
8090 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8091 using a backslash ('\').
8092
8093 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8094 only related to authentication.
8095
8096 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8097 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8098 unobvious parameters.
8099
8100 Example :
8101 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8102 backend public_www
8103 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8104 stats enable
8105 stats hide-version
8106 stats scope .
8107 stats uri /admin?stats
8108 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8109 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8110 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8111
8112 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8113 backend private_monitoring
8114 stats enable
8115 stats uri /admin?stats
8116 stats refresh 5s
8117
8118 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8119
8120
8121stats refresh <delay>
8122 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008124 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008125 Arguments :
8126 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8127 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8128 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8129 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8130 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8131 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8132
8133 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8134 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8135 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8136 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8137
8138 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8139 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8140 unobvious parameters.
8141
8142 Example :
8143 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8144 backend public_www
8145 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8146 stats enable
8147 stats hide-version
8148 stats scope .
8149 stats uri /admin?stats
8150 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8151 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8152 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8153
8154 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8155 backend private_monitoring
8156 stats enable
8157 stats uri /admin?stats
8158 stats refresh 5s
8159
8160 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8161
8162
8163stats scope { <name> | "." }
8164 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008166 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008167 Arguments :
8168 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8169 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8170 section in which the statement appears.
8171
8172 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8173 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8174 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8175 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8176 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8177 exists.
8178
8179 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8180 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8181 unobvious parameters.
8182
8183 Example :
8184 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8185 backend public_www
8186 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8187 stats enable
8188 stats hide-version
8189 stats scope .
8190 stats uri /admin?stats
8191 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8192 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8193 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8194
8195 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8196 backend private_monitoring
8197 stats enable
8198 stats uri /admin?stats
8199 stats refresh 5s
8200
8201 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8202
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008203
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008204stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008205 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008207 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008208
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008209 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008210 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8211
8212 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8213 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8214
8215 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8216 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008217 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008218
8219 Example :
8220 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8221 backend private_monitoring
8222 stats enable
8223 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8224 stats uri /admin?stats
8225 stats refresh 5s
8226
8227 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8228 global section.
8229
8230
8231stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008232 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8234 yes | yes | yes | yes
8235 Arguments : none
8236
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008237 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008238 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8239 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8240 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8241 - IP (socket, server)
8242 - cookie (backend, server)
8243
8244 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8245 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008246 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008247
8248 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8249
8250
8251stats show-node [ <name> ]
8252 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008254 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008255 Arguments:
8256 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8257 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8258
8259 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8260 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008261 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008262
8263 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8264 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8265 unobvious parameters.
8266
8267 Example:
8268 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8269 backend private_monitoring
8270 stats enable
8271 stats show-node Europe-1
8272 stats uri /admin?stats
8273 stats refresh 5s
8274
8275 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8276 section.
8277
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008278
8279stats uri <prefix>
8280 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008282 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008283 Arguments :
8284 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8285 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8286 query string.
8287
8288 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8289 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8290 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8291 possible to reach it in the application.
8292
8293 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008294 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008295 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8296 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8297 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8298 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8299
8300 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8301 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8302 an address or a port to statistics only.
8303
8304 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8305 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8306 unobvious parameters.
8307
8308 Example :
8309 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8310 backend public_www
8311 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8312 stats enable
8313 stats hide-version
8314 stats scope .
8315 stats uri /admin?stats
8316 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8317 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8318 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8319
8320 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8321 backend private_monitoring
8322 stats enable
8323 stats uri /admin?stats
8324 stats refresh 5s
8325
8326 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8327
8328
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008329stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8330 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008332 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008333
8334 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008335 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008336 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8337 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8338 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8339
8340 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8341 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8342 the "stick-table" statement.
8343
8344 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8345 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8346 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8347 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8348 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8349
8350 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8351 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8352 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8353 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8354 transformation rules.
8355
8356 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8357 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8358 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8359 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8360 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8361 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8362 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8363
8364 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8365 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8366 ACL based conditions.
8367
8368 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8369 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8370 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8371 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8372
8373 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8374 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8375 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8376 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8377
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008378 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8379 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8380 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8381
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008382 Example :
8383 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8384 # last 30 minutes
8385 backend pop
8386 mode tcp
8387 balance roundrobin
8388 stick store-request src
8389 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8390 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8391 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8392
8393 backend smtp
8394 mode tcp
8395 balance roundrobin
8396 stick match src table pop
8397 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8398 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8399
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008400 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008401 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008402
8403
8404stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8405 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8407 no | no | yes | yes
8408
8409 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8410 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8411 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8412 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8413
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008414 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8415 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8416 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8417
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008418 Examples :
8419 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008420 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008421
8422 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8423 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8424 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8425
8426
8427 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8428 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8429 backend http
8430 mode http
8431 balance roundrobin
8432 stick on src table https
8433 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8434 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8435 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8436
8437 backend https
8438 mode tcp
8439 balance roundrobin
8440 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8441 stick on src
8442 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8443 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8444
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008445 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008446
8447
8448stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8449 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8451 no | no | yes | yes
8452
8453 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008454 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008455 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8456 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8457 server is selected.
8458
8459 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8460 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8461 the "stick-table" statement.
8462
8463 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8464 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8465 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8466 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8467 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8468 address.
8469
8470 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8471 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8472 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8473 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8474 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8475 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8476 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8477 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8478 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8479 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8480
8481 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8482 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8483 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8484 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8485 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8486 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8487 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8488
8489 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8490 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8491 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8492 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8493
8494 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8495 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8496 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8497 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8498 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8499 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008500 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8501 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8502 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8503 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8504 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8505 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008506
8507 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8508 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8509 the request.
8510
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008511 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8512 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8513 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8514
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008515 Example :
8516 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8517 # last 30 minutes
8518 backend pop
8519 mode tcp
8520 balance roundrobin
8521 stick store-request src
8522 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8523 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8524 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8525
8526 backend smtp
8527 mode tcp
8528 balance roundrobin
8529 stick match src table pop
8530 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8531 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8532
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008533 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008534 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008535
8536
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008537stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008538 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8539 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008540 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008542 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008543
8544 Arguments :
8545 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8546 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8547 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8548 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8549
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008550 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8551 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8552 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8553 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8554
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008555 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8556 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8557 instance.
8558
8559 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8560 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8561 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8562 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8563 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8564 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008565 to 32 characters.
8566
8567 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8568 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8569 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008570 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008571 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8572 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008573
8574 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008575 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8576 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008577 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8578 increase.
8579
8580 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008581 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8582 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8583 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008584
8585 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8586 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8587 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8588 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8589 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8590 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8591 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8592 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8593 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8594 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8595 parameter (see below).
8596
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008597 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8598 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8599 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8600 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8601 soft restart.
8602
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008603 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8604 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008605
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008606 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8607 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8608 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8609 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008610 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008611 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008612 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8613 if not expiration delay is specified.
8614
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008615 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8616 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8617 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8618 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008619 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8620 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8621 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8622 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8623 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8624 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8625 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8626 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8627 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8628 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8629 types and their arguments.
8630
8631 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8632 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8633 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8634 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8635
8636 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8637 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8638 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8639 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8640
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008641 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8642 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8643 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8644 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8645 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8646 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8647
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008648 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8649 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8650 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8651 they were received.
8652
8653 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8654 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8655 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8656 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8657 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8658
8659 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8660 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8661 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8662 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8663 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8664
8665 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8666 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8667 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8668
8669 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8670 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8671 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8672 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8673 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8674
8675 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8676 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8677 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8678 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8679 the client side.
8680
8681 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8682 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8683 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8684 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8685 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8686 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8687 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8688
8689 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8690 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8691 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8692 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8693 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8694 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8695 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8696
8697 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8698 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8699 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8700 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8701 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8702 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8703
8704 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8705 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8706 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8707 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8708
8709 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8710 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8711 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8712 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8713 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8714 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8715 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8716 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8717 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8718 recommended for better fairness.
8719
8720 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8721 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8722 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8723 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8724
8725 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8726 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8727 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8728 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8729 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8730 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8731 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8732 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8733 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8734 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008735
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008736 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8737 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008738 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8739 reference it.
8740
8741 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8742 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008743 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8744 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8745 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008746
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008747 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8748 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8749 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8750 something that can be ignored.
8751
8752 Example:
8753 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8754 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8755 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8756 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8757
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008758 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008759 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008760
8761
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008762stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008763 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8765 no | no | yes | yes
8766
8767 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008768 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008769 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8770 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8771 server is selected.
8772
8773 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8774 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8775 the "stick-table" statement.
8776
8777 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8778 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8779 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8780 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8781
8782 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8783 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8784 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8785 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8786 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8787 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008788 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008789 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8790 rules.
8791
8792 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8793 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8794 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8795 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8796 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8797 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8798 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8799
8800 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8801 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8802 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8803 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8804
8805 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8806 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8807 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8808 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8809 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8810 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008811 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8812 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8813 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8814 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8815 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8816 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8817 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8818 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8819 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008820
8821 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8822
8823 Example :
8824 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8825 backend https
8826 mode tcp
8827 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008828 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008829 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008830
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008831 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8832 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8833
8834 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8835 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8836 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8837
8838 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8839 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008840
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008841 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8842 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8843 # at offset 44.
8844
8845 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8846 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8847
8848 # Learn on response if server hello.
8849 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008850
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008851 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8852 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8853
8854 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8855 extraction.
8856
8857
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008858tcp-check connect [params*]
8859 Opens a new connection
8860 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8861 no | no | yes | yes
8862
8863 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8864 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8865 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8866
8867 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8868 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8869 of the sequence.
8870
8871 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8872 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8873 do.
8874
8875 Parameters :
8876 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8877 use the TCP connection.
8878
8879 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8880 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8881 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8882
8883 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8884
8885 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8886
8887 Examples:
8888 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8889 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8890 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8891 option tcp-check
8892 tcp-check connect
8893 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8894 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8895 tcp-check send \r\n
8896 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8897 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8898 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8899 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8900 tcp-check send \r\n
8901 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8902 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8903
8904 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8905 option tcp-check
8906 tcp-check connect port 110
8907 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8908 tcp-check connect port 143
8909 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8910 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8911
8912 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8913
8914
8915tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8916 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8917 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8918 no | no | yes | yes
8919
8920 Arguments :
8921 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8922 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8923 binary.
8924 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8925 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8926 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8927
8928 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8929 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8930 with the usual backslash ('\').
8931 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8932 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8933 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8934 used upper or lower case.
8935
8936
8937 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8938
8939 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8940 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8941 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8942 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8943 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8944 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8945 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8946 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8947
8948 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8949 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8950 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8951 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8952 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8953 expression.
8954
8955 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8956 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8957 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8958 this exact hexadecimal string.
8959 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8960
8961 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8962 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8963 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8964 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8965 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8966 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8967 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8968 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8969 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8970 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8971 the null character.
8972
8973 Examples :
8974 # perform a POP check
8975 option tcp-check
8976 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8977
8978 # perform an IMAP check
8979 option tcp-check
8980 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8981
8982 # look for the redis master server
8983 option tcp-check
8984 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008985 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008986 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8987 tcp-check expect string role:master
8988 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8989 tcp-check expect string +OK
8990
8991
8992 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8993 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8994
8995
8996tcp-check send <data>
8997 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8998 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8999 no | no | yes | yes
9000
9001 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9002 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9003
9004 Examples :
9005 # look for the redis master server
9006 option tcp-check
9007 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9008 tcp-check expect string role:master
9009
9010 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9011 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9012
9013
9014tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
9015 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
9016 tcp health check
9017 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9018 no | no | yes | yes
9019
9020 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9021 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9022 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
9023 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9024 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9025 hexadecimal string.
9026 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9027
9028 Examples :
9029 # redis check in binary
9030 option tcp-check
9031 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9032 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9033
9034
9035 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9036 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9037
9038
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009039tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9040 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9042 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009043 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009044 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9045 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009047 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009048
9049 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9050 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009051 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9052 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9053 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9054 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9055 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9056 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009058 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9059 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9060 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9061 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009062
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009063 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009064 - accept :
9065 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9066 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9067 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009068
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009069 - reject :
9070 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9071 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9072 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9073 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9074 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9075 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9076 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9077 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9078 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9079 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9080 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009081 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009082
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009083 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9084 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9085 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9086 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9087 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9088 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9089 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9090 hosts.
9091
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009092 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9093 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9094 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9095 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9096 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9097 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9098 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9099 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9100
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009101 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9102 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9103 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9104 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9105 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9106 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9107 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9108 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9109 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009110 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9111 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009112
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009113 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009114 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02009115 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009116 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009117 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9118 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009119 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009120 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
9121 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
9122 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
9123 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
9124 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009125
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009126 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009127 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009128 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009129 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
9130 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9131 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9132 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009133
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009134 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9135 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9136 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9137 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009138
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009139 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9140 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9141 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9142 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9143 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009144 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9145 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9146 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9147 layer7 information is extracted.
9148
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009149 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9150 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9151 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9152 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9153 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009154
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009155 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9156 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9157 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9158 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9159
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009160 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9161 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9162 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9163 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9164 continues.
9165
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009166 - set-src <expr> :
9167 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9168 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9169 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9170 set-src"
9171
9172 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9173 followed by some converters.
9174
9175 Example:
9176
9177 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9178
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009179 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9180 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009181
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009182 - set-src-port <expr> :
9183 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9184 expression.
9185
9186 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9187 followed by some converters.
9188
9189 Example:
9190
9191 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9192
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009193 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9194 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9195 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009196
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009197 - set-dst <expr> :
9198 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9199 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9200 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9201 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9202 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9203
9204 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9205 followed by some converters.
9206
9207 Example:
9208
9209 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9210 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9211
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009212 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9213 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9214
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009215 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9216 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9217 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9218 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9219
9220
9221 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9222 followed by some converters.
9223
9224 Example:
9225
9226 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9227
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009228 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9229 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9230 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9231
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009232 - "silent-drop" :
9233 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9234 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9235 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9236 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9237 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9238 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9239 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9240 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9241 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9242 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9243 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9244 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9245 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9246 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9247 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9248 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9249
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009250 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9251 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9252 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009253
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009254 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9255 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9256 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009257
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009258 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009259 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009260 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009261
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009262 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9263 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9264 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009265
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009266 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009267 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9268 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009269
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009270 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9271
9272 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9273
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009274 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9275
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009276 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009277
9278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009279tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9280 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009282 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009283 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009284 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9285 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009286
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009287 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009288
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009289 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9290 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9291 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9292 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9293 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009294
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009295 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9296 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9297 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9298 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009299 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9300 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9301 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9302 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9303 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9304 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009305 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009306 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009307
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009308 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9309 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9310 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9311 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009312
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009313 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009314 - accept : the request is accepted
9315 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9316 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009317 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009318 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009319 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009320 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009321 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009322 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009323 - send-spoe-group <engin-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009324
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009325 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9326 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009327
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009328 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9329 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9330 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9331 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9332 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9333 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009334
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009335 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009336 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9337 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009338
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009339 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009340 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9341 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9342 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9343 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009344 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9345 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9346 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009347
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009348 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009349 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9350 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9351 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009352
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009353 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009354 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9355 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009356
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009357 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9358 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009359 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009360 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9361 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009362 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009363 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009364 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009365 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9366 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009367 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009368 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9369 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009370
9371 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9372 followed by some converters.
9373
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009374 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9375 <var-name>.
9376
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009377 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9378 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9379 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9380 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9381 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9382
9383 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9384
9385 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9386
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009387 Example:
9388
9389 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009390 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009391
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009392 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009393 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9394 # and reject everything else.
9395 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9396 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009397 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009398 tcp-request content reject
9399
9400 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009401 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9402 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9403 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009404 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009405
9406 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9407 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9408 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009409 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009410 tcp-request content reject
9411
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009412 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009413 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009414 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009415 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009416 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9417 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009418
9419 Example:
9420 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9421 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009422 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009423
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009424 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009425 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009426
9427 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009428 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009429 # protecting all our sites
9430 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009431 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9432 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009433 ...
9434 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9435
9436 backend http_dynamic
9437 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009438 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009439 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009440 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009441 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009442 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009443 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009444
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009445 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009446
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009447 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9448 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009449
9450
9451tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9452 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009454 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009455 Arguments :
9456 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9457 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9458 as explained at the top of this document.
9459
9460 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9461 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9462 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9463 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9464 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9465
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009466 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9467 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9468 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9469 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9470
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009471 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9472 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009473 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009474 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009475 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9476 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9477 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9478 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009479
9480 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9481 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9482 it pass through unaffected.
9483
9484 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9485 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9486 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009487 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009488 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9489 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009490 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9491 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9492 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009493
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009494 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009495 "timeout client".
9496
9497
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009498tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9499 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9501 no | no | yes | yes
9502 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009503 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9504 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009505
9506 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9507
9508 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9509 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9510 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009511 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9512 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009513
9514 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9515
9516 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9517 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9518 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9519 inserted.
9520
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009521 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009522 - accept :
9523 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9524 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9525 the rules evaluation.
9526
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009527 - close :
9528 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9529 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9530 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9531 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9532 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9533 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009534 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009535 protocols.
9536
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009537 - reject :
9538 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9539 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009540 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009541
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009542 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9543 Sets a variable.
9544
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009545 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9546 Unsets a variable.
9547
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009548 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9549 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9550 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9551 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9552
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009553 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9554 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9555 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9556 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9557 continues.
9558
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009559 - "silent-drop" :
9560 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9561 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9562 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9563 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9564 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9565 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9566 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9567 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9568 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9569 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9570 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9571 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9572 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9573 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9574 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9575 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9576
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009577 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9578 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9579
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009580 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9581 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9582 for changing the default action to a reject.
9583
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009584 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9585 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9586 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9587 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009588 period.
9589
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009590 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9591 declared inline.
9592
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009593 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9594 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009595 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009596 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9597 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009598 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009599 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009600 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009601 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9602 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009603 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009604 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9605 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009606
9607 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9608 followed by some converters.
9609
9610 Example:
9611
9612 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9613
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009614 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9615 <var-name>.
9616
9617 Example:
9618
9619 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9620
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009621 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9622 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9623 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9624 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9625 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9626
9627 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9628
9629 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9630
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009631 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9632
9633 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9634
9635
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009636tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9637 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9639 no | yes | yes | no
9640 Arguments :
9641 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9642 below.
9643
9644 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9645
9646 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9647 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9648 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9649 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9650 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9651 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9652 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9653 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9654 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9655 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9656 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9657 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9658 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9659 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9660 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9661 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9662 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9663 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9664 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9665 instead.
9666
9667 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9668 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9669 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9670 rules which may be inserted.
9671
9672 Several types of actions are supported :
9673 - accept : the request is accepted
9674 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9675 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9676 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9677 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9678 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009679 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009680 - silent-drop
9681
9682 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9683 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9684 sections for a complete description.
9685
9686 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9687 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9688 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9689
9690 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9691 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9692 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9693 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9694 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9695
9696 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9697 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9698
9699 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9700 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9701 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9702
9703 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9704 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9705 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9706
9707 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9708 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9709 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9710
9711 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9712 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9713 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9714
9715 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9716
9717 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9718
9719
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009720tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9721 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9723 no | no | yes | yes
9724 Arguments :
9725 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9726 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9727 as explained at the top of this document.
9728
9729 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9730
9731
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009732timeout check <timeout>
9733 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9734 established.
9735
9736 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9737 yes | no | yes | yes
9738 Arguments:
9739 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9740 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9741 as explained at the top of this document.
9742
9743 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9744 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9745 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9746 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009747 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9748 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9749 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009750
9751 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9752 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9753
9754 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9755 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009756 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009757
9758 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9759 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9760 forget about it.
9761
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009762 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9763 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009764
9765
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009766timeout client <timeout>
9767timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9768 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9770 yes | yes | yes | no
9771 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009772 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009773 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9774 as explained at the top of this document.
9775
9776 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9777 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9778 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009779 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9780 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9781 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9782 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009783 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9784 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9785 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009786 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009787 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009788 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9789 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009790 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9791 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009792
9793 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9794 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9795 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9796 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9797 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9798 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9799
9800 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9801 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9802 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9803
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009804 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9805 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009806
9807
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009808timeout client-fin <timeout>
9809 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9811 yes | yes | yes | no
9812 Arguments :
9813 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9814 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9815 as explained at the top of this document.
9816
9817 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9818 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9819 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9820 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9821 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9822 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9823 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9824 down in one direction.
9825
9826 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9827 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9828 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9829
9830 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9831
9832
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009833timeout connect <timeout>
9834timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9835 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9837 yes | no | yes | yes
9838 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009839 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009840 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9841 as explained at the top of this document.
9842
9843 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009844 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009845 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009846 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009847 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9848 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009849
9850 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9851 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9852 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9853 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9854 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9855 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9856
9857 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9858 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9859 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9860
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009861 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9862 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009863
9864
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009865timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9866 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9868 yes | yes | yes | yes
9869 Arguments :
9870 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9871 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9872 as explained at the top of this document.
9873
9874 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9875 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9876 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9877 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9878 once the request has started to present itself.
9879
9880 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9881 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9882 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9883 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9884 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9885
9886 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9887 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9888 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9889 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9890
9891 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9892 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9893 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9894 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9895 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009896 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009897
9898 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9899 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9900 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9901 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9902
9903 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9904
9905
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009906timeout http-request <timeout>
9907 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009909 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009910 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009911 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009912 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9913 as explained at the top of this document.
9914
9915 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9916 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9917 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9918 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9919 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9920 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9921 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009922 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9923 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9924 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9925 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9926 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009927 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9928 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009929
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009930 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9931 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9932 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9933 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9934 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009935 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009936
9937 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9938 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9939 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9940 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9941 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9942
9943 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009944 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9945 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9946 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009947
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009948 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009949 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009950
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009951
9952timeout queue <timeout>
9953 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9955 yes | no | yes | yes
9956 Arguments :
9957 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9958 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9959 as explained at the top of this document.
9960
9961 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9962 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9963 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9964 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9965 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9966
9967 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9968 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9969 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9970 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9971
9972 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9973
9974
9975timeout server <timeout>
9976timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9977 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9979 yes | no | yes | yes
9980 Arguments :
9981 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9982 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9983 as explained at the top of this document.
9984
9985 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9986 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9987 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9988 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9989 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9990 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9991 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9992
9993 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9994 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9995 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9996 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9997 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009998 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009999 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010000 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10001 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
10002 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10003 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010004
10005 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10006 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10007 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10008 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10009 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10010 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10011
10012 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10013 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10014 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10015
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010016 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010017
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010018
10019timeout server-fin <timeout>
10020 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10022 yes | no | yes | yes
10023 Arguments :
10024 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10025 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10026 as explained at the top of this document.
10027
10028 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10029 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10030 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10031 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10032 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10033 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10034 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10035 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10036 situations, it should not be needed.
10037
10038 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10039 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10040 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10041
10042 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10043
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010044
10045timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010046 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10048 yes | yes | yes | yes
10049 Arguments :
10050 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10051 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10052 as explained at the top of this document.
10053
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010054 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10055 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10056 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10057 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010058
10059 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10060 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10061 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10062 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010063 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010064
10065 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10066
10067
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010068timeout tunnel <timeout>
10069 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10071 yes | no | yes | yes
10072 Arguments :
10073 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10074 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10075 as explained at the top of this document.
10076
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010077 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010078 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10079 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10080 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
10081 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
10082 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
10083 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10084 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10085 specified.
10086
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010087 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10088 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10089 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10090 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10091 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10092 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10093 state.
10094
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010095 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10096 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10097 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10098 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
10099 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
10100
10101 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10102 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10103 forget about it.
10104
10105 Example :
10106 defaults http
10107 option http-server-close
10108 timeout connect 5s
10109 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010110 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010111 timeout server 30s
10112 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10113
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010114 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010115
10116
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010117transparent (deprecated)
10118 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010120 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010121 Arguments : none
10122
10123 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10124 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10125 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10126 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10127 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10128 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10129 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10130 appropriate server.
10131
10132 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10133
10134 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10135 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10136
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010137 See also: "option transparent"
10138
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010139unique-id-format <string>
10140 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10142 yes | yes | yes | no
10143 Arguments :
10144 <string> is a log-format string.
10145
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010146 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10147 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10148 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10149 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010150
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010151 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10152 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10153 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10154 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10155 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10156 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10157 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10158 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010159
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010160 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10161 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010162
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010163 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010164
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010165 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010166
10167 will generate:
10168
10169 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10170
10171 See also: "unique-id-header"
10172
10173unique-id-header <name>
10174 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10176 yes | yes | yes | no
10177 Arguments :
10178 <name> is the name of the header.
10179
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010180 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10181 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010182
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010183 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010184
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010185 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010186 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10187
10188 will generate:
10189
10190 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10191
10192 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010193
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010194use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010195 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10197 no | yes | yes | no
10198 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010199 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10200 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010201
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010202 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10203 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010204
10205 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10206 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10207 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010208 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10209 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10210 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10211 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010212
10213 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10214 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10215 assign the backend.
10216
10217 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10218 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10219 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10220 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10221 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10222 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10223
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010224 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010225 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010226 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10227 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10228 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10229
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010230 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10231 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10232 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10233 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10234 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10235 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10236 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10237 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10238 cannot be forced from the request.
10239
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010240 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010241 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10242 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10243
10244 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10245 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010246
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010247
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010248use-server <server> if <condition>
10249use-server <server> unless <condition>
10250 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10252 no | no | yes | yes
10253 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010254 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010255
10256 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10257
10258 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10259 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10260 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10261
10262 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10263 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10264 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10265 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10266 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10267 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10268 matches will assign the server.
10269
10270 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10271 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10272 with the next rules until one matches.
10273
10274 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10275 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10276 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10277 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10278
10279 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10280 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10281 stripped.
10282
10283 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10284 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10285 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10286 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10287
10288 Example :
10289 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10290 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10291 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10292 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10293 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10294 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010295 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010296 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10297 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10298
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010299 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010300
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010301
103025. Bind and Server options
10303--------------------------
10304
10305The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10306depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10307settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10308written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10309described in this section.
10310
10311
103125.1. Bind options
10313-----------------
10314
10315The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10316as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10317no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10318parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10319while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10320provided immediately after the setting name.
10321
10322The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10323
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010324accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10325 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10326 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10327 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10328 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10329 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10330 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10331 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10332 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10333 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010334 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10335 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10336 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010337
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010338accept-proxy
10339 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010340 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10341 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010342 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10343 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10344 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10345 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10346 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10347 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10348 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010349 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10350 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010351
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010352allow-0rtt
10353 Allow receiving early data when using TLS 1.3. This is disabled by default,
10354 due to security considerations.
10355
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010356alpn <protocols>
10357 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10358 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10359 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10360 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10361 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10362 initial NPN extension.
10363
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010364backlog <backlog>
10365 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10366 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10367
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010368curves <curves>
10369 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10370 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10371 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10372 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10373 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10374 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10375
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010376ecdhe <named curve>
10377 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010378 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10379 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010380
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010381ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010382 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10383 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10384 client's certificate.
10385
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010386ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10387 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10388 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10389 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10390 error is ignored.
10391
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010392ca-sign-file <cafile>
10393 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10394 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10395 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10396 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10397 'generate-certificates' for details.
10398
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010399ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010400 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10401 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10402 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10403 'generate-certificates' for details.
10404
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010405ciphers <ciphers>
10406 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10407 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010408 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010409 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10410 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
Daniel Schneller87e43022017-09-01 19:29:57 +020010411 Depending on the compatiblity and security requirements, the list of suitable
10412 ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background information and
10413 recommendations see e. g. (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS)
10414 and (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010415
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010416crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010417 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10418 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10419 to verify client's certificate.
10420
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010421crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010422 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10423 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10424 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10425 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10426 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10427 file.
10428
10429 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10430 are loaded.
10431
10432 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010433 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010434 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10435 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10436 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10437 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10438 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10439 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10440 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010441
10442 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10443 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10444 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10445 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010446 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10447 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010448
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010449 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010450
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010451 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10452 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010453 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010454 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10455 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10456 clients).
10457
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010458 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10459 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10460 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10461 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10462 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10463 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10464 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10465 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10466 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10467 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10468 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10469 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10470 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10471
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010472 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10473 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10474 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10475 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10476 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10477
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010478 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10479 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10480 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10481 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010482
10483 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10484 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10485 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10486 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10487 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10488 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10489 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10490 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10491 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10492
10493 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10494
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010495 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010496 a cert bundle.
10497
10498 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10499 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10500 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10501 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10502 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10503 provide multi-cert support.
10504
10505 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10506
10507 Filename | CN | SAN
10508 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10509 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010510 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010511 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10512 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10513
10514 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10515 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10516 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10517 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010518 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10519 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10520 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010521
10522 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10523 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10524
10525 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10526 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10527 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10528
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010529crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010530 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10531 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010532 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010533 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010534
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010535crt-list <file>
10536 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010537 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10538 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010539
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010540 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10541
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010542 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10543 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010544 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010545 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010546
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010547 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10548 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10549 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10550 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10551 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10552 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10553 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10554 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010555
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010556 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010557 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010558 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10559 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10560 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010561
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010562 crt-list file example:
10563 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010564 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010565 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010566 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010567
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010568defer-accept
10569 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10570 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10571 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10572 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10573 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10574 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10575 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10576 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10577 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10578 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10579 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10580
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010581expose-fd listeners
10582 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10583 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010584 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10585 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010586 See alors "-x" in the management guide.
10587
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010588force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010589 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010590 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010591 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010592 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010593
10594force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010595 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010596 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010597 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010598
10599force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010600 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010601 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010602 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010603
10604force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010605 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010606 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010607 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010608
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010609force-tlsv13
10610 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10611 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010612 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010613
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010614generate-certificates
10615 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10616 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10617 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10618 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10619 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10620 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10621 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10622 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10623 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10624 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10625 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10626
10627 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10628 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10629 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10630 certificate is used many times.
10631
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010632gid <gid>
10633 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10634 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10635 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10636 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10637 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10638
10639group <group>
10640 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10641 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10642 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10643 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10644 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10645
10646id <id>
10647 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10648 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10649 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10650 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10651
10652interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010653 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10654 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10655 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10656 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10657 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10658 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10659 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010660
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010661level <level>
10662 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10663 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10664 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10665 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10666 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10667 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10668 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10669 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10670 counters).
10671 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10672 all counters).
10673
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010674severity-output <format>
10675 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10676 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10677 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10678 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10679 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10680 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10681 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10682 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10683 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10684 rfc5424 convention.
10685
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010686maxconn <maxconn>
10687 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10688 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10689 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10690 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10691 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10692 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10693 eat all memory.
10694
10695mode <mode>
10696 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10697 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10698 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10699 UNIX sockets.
10700
10701mss <maxseg>
10702 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10703 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10704 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10705 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10706 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10707 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10708 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10709 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10710 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10711 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10712 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10713
10714name <name>
10715 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10716 page.
10717
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010718namespace <name>
10719 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10720 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10721 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10722 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10723
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010724nice <nice>
10725 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10726 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10727 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10728 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10729 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10730 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10731 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10732 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10733 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10734 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10735 one for an RDP socket.
10736
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010737no-ca-names
10738 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10739 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10740
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010741no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010742 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010743 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010744 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010745 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010746 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10747 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010748
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010749no-tls-tickets
10750 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10751 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10752 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010753 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10754 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010755
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010756no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010757 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010758 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010759 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010760 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010761 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10762 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010763
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010764no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010765 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010766 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010767 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010768 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010769 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10770 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010771
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010772no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010773 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010774 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010775 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010776 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010777 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10778 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010779
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010780no-tlsv13
10781 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10782 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10783 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10784 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010785 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10786 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010787
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010788npn <protocols>
10789 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10790 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10791 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10792 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010793 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10794 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010795
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010796prefer-client-ciphers
10797 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10798 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10799 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10800
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010801process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10802 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10803 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10804 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10805 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10806 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10807 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10808 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010809 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10810 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10811 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10812 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10813 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10814 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10815 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010816
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010817ssl
10818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010819 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010820 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10821 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020010822 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
10823 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010824
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010825ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10826 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10827 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10828 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10829
10830ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10831 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10832 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10833 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10834
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010835strict-sni
10836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10837 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10838 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10839 See the "crt" option for more information.
10840
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010841tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010842 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010843 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10844 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010845 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010846 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10847 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10848 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10849 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10850 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10851 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10852 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10853
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010854tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010855 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010856 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10857 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10858 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10859 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10860 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10861 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10862 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010863 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10864 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10865 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010866
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010867tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10868 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10869 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10870 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10871 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10872 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10873 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10874 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10875 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10876 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10877 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10878
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010879transparent
10880 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10881 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10882 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10883 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10884 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10885 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10886 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10887 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10888 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10889 so check for support with your vendor.
10890
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010891v4v6
10892 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10893 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10894 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10895 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010896 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010897
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010898v6only
10899 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10900 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10901 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010902 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10903 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010904
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010905uid <uid>
10906 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10907 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10908 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10909 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10910 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10911
10912user <user>
10913 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10914 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10915 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10916 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10917 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10918
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010919verify [none|optional|required]
10920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10921 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10922 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10923 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10924 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010925 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10926 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10927 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10928 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010929
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200109305.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010931------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010933The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10934which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10935arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10936settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10937after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10938Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10939address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010941 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010942 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010943
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010944Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10945keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010947The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010948
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010949addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010950 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010951 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10952 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10953 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10954 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10955 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010956
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010957agent-check
10958 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010959 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10960 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10961 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10962 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010963
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010964 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010965 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010966 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10967 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10968 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010969
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010970 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10971 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10972 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10973 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10974 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10975
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010976 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10977 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010978
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010979 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10980 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10981 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010982
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010983 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10984 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10985 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010986
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010987 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10988 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10989 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10990 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10991 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10992 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10993 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010994
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010995 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10996 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010997
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010998 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10999 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11000 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11001 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11002 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11003 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11004 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11005 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11006 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011007
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011008 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11009 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011010 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11011 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11012 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011013 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011014
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011015 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011016 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011017
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011018agent-send <string>
11019 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11020 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11021 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11022 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11023 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11024
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011025agent-inter <delay>
11026 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11027 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11028
11029 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11030 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11031 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11032 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11033 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11034 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11035 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11036 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11037 of backends use the same servers.
11038
11039 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11040
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011041agent-addr <addr>
11042 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11043
11044 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11045 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11046 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11047 hostname, it will be resolved.
11048
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011049agent-port <port>
11050 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11051
11052 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011054backup
11055 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11056 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11057 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11058 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011059 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11060 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011061
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011062ca-file <cafile>
11063 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11064 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11065 server's certificate.
11066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011067check
11068 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011069 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11070 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11071 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11072 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11073 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11074 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11075 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011076 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11077 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011078 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11079 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011080
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011081check-send-proxy
11082 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11083 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11084 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11085 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11086 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11087 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11088 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11089
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011090check-sni
11091 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11092 over SSL.
11093
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011094check-ssl
11095 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11096 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11097 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11098 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011099 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011100 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11101 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
11102 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011103 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11104 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011105
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011106ciphers <ciphers>
11107 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011108 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011109 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11110 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11111 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11112 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11113 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11114 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011116cookie <value>
11117 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11118 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11119 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11120 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11121 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11122 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11123 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11124
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011125crl-file <crlfile>
11126 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11127 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11128 to verify server's certificate.
11129
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011130crt <cert>
11131 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11132 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11133 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11134 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11135 certificate request.
11136
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011137disabled
11138 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11139 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11140 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11141 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11142 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011143 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011144
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011145enabled
11146 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11147 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11148 default value.
11149 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11150 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011152error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011153 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11154 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11155 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011156
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011157 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011159fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011160 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11161 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11162 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11163
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011164force-sslv3
11165 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11166 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011167 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011168 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011169
11170force-tlsv10
11171 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011172 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011173 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011174
11175force-tlsv11
11176 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011177 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011178 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011179
11180force-tlsv12
11181 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011182 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011183 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011184
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011185force-tlsv13
11186 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11187 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011188 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011189
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011190id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011191 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11192 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11193 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011194
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011195init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11196 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11197 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
11198 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
11199 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11200 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11201 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11202 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11203 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11204 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11205 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11206 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11207 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
11208 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
11209 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11210 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11211 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11212 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11213 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11214 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
11215 historic behaviour.
11216
11217 Example:
11218 defaults
11219 # never fail on address resolution
11220 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11221
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011222inter <delay>
11223fastinter <delay>
11224downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011225 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11226 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11227 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11228 between checks depending on the server state :
11229
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011230 Server state | Interval used
11231 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11232 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11233 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11234 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11235 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11236 or yet unchecked. |
11237 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11238 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11239 | "inter" otherwise.
11240 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011242 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11243 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11244 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11245 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011246 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11247 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11248 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11249 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11250 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011252maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011253 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11254 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11255 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11256 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11257 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11258 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11259 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11260 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11261
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011262maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011263 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11264 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11265 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11266 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11267 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11268 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11269 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011271minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011272 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11273 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11274 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11275 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11276 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11277 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011278 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011279 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011280
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011281namespace <name>
11282 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11283 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11284 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11285 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11286
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011287no-agent-check
11288 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11289 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11290 default value.
11291 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11292 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11293
11294no-backup
11295 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11296 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11297 default value.
11298 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11299 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11300
11301no-check
11302 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11303 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11304 default value.
11305 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11306 "default-server" "check" setting.
11307
11308no-check-ssl
11309 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11310 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11311 default value.
11312 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11313 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11314
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011315no-send-proxy
11316 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11317 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11318 default value.
11319 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11320 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11321
11322no-send-proxy-v2
11323 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11324 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11325 default value.
11326 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11327 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11328
11329no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11330 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11331 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11332 default value.
11333 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11334 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11335
11336no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11337 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11338 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11339 default value.
11340 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11341 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11342
11343no-ssl
11344 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11345 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11346 default value.
11347 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11348 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11349
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011350no-ssl-reuse
11351 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11352 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11353 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11354 and for paranoid users.
11355
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011356no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011357 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11358 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011359 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011360
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011361 Supported in default-server: No
11362
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011363no-tls-tickets
11364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11365 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11366 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011367 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11368 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011369 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011370
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011371no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011372 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011373 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11374 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011375 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11376 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011377 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011378
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011379 Supported in default-server: No
11380
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011381no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011382 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011383 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11384 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011385 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11386 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011387 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011388
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011389 Supported in default-server: No
11390
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011391no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011392 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011393 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11394 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011395 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11396 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011397 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011398
11399 Supported in default-server: No
11400
11401no-tlsv13
11402 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11403 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11404 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11405 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11406 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011407 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011408
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011409 Supported in default-server: No
11410
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011411no-verifyhost
11412 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11413 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11414 default value.
11415 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11416 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011417
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011418non-stick
11419 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11420 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11421 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011423observe <mode>
11424 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11425 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11426 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11427 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11428 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11429 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011430 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011431
11432 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11433
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011434on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011435 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11436 Currently, four modes are available:
11437 - fastinter: force fastinter
11438 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11439 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11440 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11441 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11442
11443 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11444
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011445on-marked-down <action>
11446 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11447 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011448 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11449 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11450 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11451 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11452 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11453 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11454 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11455 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011456
11457 Actions are disabled by default
11458
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011459on-marked-up <action>
11460 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11461 Currently one action is available:
11462 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11463 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11464 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11465 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11466 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11467 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11468 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11469 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11470
11471 Actions are disabled by default
11472
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011473port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011474 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11475 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11476 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11477 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11478 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11479 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11480
11481redir <prefix>
11482 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11483 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11484 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11485 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11486 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11487 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11488 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11489 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011490 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011491 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11492 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11493 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11494 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11495 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11496
11497 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011499rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011500 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11501 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11502 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11503
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011504resolve-prefer <family>
11505 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11506 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11507 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11508 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11509
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011510 Default value: ipv6
11511
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011512 Example:
11513
11514 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011515
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011516resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11517 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11518 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011519 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011520 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11521 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11522 configured network, another address is selected.
11523
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011524 Example:
11525
11526 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011527
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011528resolvers <id>
11529 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11530 hostname.
11531
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011532 Example:
11533
11534 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011535
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011536 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011537
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011538send-proxy
11539 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11540 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11541 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11542 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011543 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11544 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11545 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11546 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11547 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11548 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11549 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11550 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11551 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11552 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011553 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11554 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011555
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011556send-proxy-v2
11557 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11558 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11559 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11560 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011561 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11562 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11563 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11564 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011565
11566send-proxy-v2-ssl
11567 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11568 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11569 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11570 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11571 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11572 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11573 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011574 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11575 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011576
11577send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11578 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11579 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11580 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11581 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11582 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11583 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11584 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11585 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011586 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11587 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011589slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011590 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11591 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11592 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11593 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11594 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11595 parameters :
11596
11597 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11598 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11599
11600 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11601 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11602 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11603 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11604
11605 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11606 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11607 seen as failed.
11608
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011609sni <expression>
11610 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11611 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11612 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11613 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011614 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11615 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011616 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11617 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011618
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011619source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011620source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011621source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011622 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11623 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11624 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11625 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11626
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011627 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11628 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11629 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11630 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11631 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11632 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11633 server.
11634
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011635 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11636 specifying the source address without port(s).
11637
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011638ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011639 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11640 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11641 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11642 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11643 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11644 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011645 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11646 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011647
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011648ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11649 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11650 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11651 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11652
11653ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11654 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11655 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11656 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11657
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011658ssl-reuse
11659 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11660 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11661 default value.
11662 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11663 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11664
11665stick
11666 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11667 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11668 default value.
11669 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11670 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011671
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011672tcp-ut <delay>
11673 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11674 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11675 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011676 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011677 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11678 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11679 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11680 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11681 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11682 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11683 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11684 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11685 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11686
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011687track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011688 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11689 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11690 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11691 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011692 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11693
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011694tls-tickets
11695 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11696 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11697 default value.
11698 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11699 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011700
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011701verify [none|required]
11702 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011703 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011704 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
11705 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
11706 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributs match either
11707 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
11708 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
11709 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
11710 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
11711 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
11712 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
11713 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
11714 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011715
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011716verifyhost <hostname>
11717 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011718 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
11719 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
11720 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
11721 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
11722 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
11723 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
11724 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
11725 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011727weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011728 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11729 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11730 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011731 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11732 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11733 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11734 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11735 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11736 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011737
11738
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117395.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11740-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011741
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011742HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11743using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11744configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011745This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11746can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11747workload.
11748This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11749resolution at run time.
11750Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11751carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11752
11753
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117545.3.1. Global overview
11755----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011756
11757As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11758different steps of the process life:
11759
11760 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11761 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11762 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11763
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011764 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
11765 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011766
11767A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11768 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11769 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11770 resolution to know this new IP.
11771
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011772When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
11773HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
11774SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
11775from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
11776will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
11777will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020011778
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011779A few things important to notice:
11780 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11781 first valid response.
11782
11783 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11784 servers return an error.
11785
11786
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117875.3.2. The resolvers section
11788----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011789
11790This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011791HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
11792contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011793
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011794When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11795uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11796is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11797answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11798
11799When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011800used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011801
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011802 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
11803 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
11804 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011805
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011806 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
11807 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011808
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011809 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
11810 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
11811 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011812
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011813For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
11814following scenarios are possible:
11815
11816 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
11817 ignored
11818
11819 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11820 applied
11821
11822 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11823 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
11824
11825 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
11826 retries the query with a new type
11827
11828 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
11829 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011830
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011831As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
11832a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011833<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011834
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011835
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011836resolvers <resolvers id>
11837 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11838
11839A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11840
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011841accepted_payload_size <nb>
11842 Defines the maxium payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011843 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011844 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
11845 by RFC 6891)
11846
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011847 Note: to get bigger responses but still be sure that responses won't be
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011848 dropped on the wire, one can choose a value between 1280 and 1410.
11849
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011850 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
11851
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011852nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11853 DNS server description:
11854 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11855 <ip> : IP address of the server
11856 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11857
11858hold <status> <period>
11859 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11860 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011861 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011862 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011863 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11864 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11865 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11866
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020011867 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011868
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011869resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020011870 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
11871 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
11872 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
11873
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011874resolve_retries <nb>
11875 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11876 giving up.
11877 Default value: 3
11878
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011879 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11880 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11881 type.
11882
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011883timeout <event> <time>
11884 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11885 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11886 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011887 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
11888 other time applied.
11889 Default value: 1s
11890 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
11891 have been received.
11892 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011893 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11894 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11895
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011896 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011897
11898 resolvers mydns
11899 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11900 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11901 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011902 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011903 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011904 hold other 30s
11905 hold refused 30s
11906 hold nx 30s
11907 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011908 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011909 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011910
11911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119126. HTTP header manipulation
11913---------------------------
11914
11915In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11916response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11917request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11918which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011919against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011920
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011921If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11922to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11923but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11924HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11925stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11926because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11927a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11928still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011930This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11931in section 4.2 :
11932
11933 - reqadd <string>
11934 - reqallow <search>
11935 - reqiallow <search>
11936 - reqdel <search>
11937 - reqidel <search>
11938 - reqdeny <search>
11939 - reqideny <search>
11940 - reqpass <search>
11941 - reqipass <search>
11942 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11943 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11944 - reqtarpit <search>
11945 - reqitarpit <search>
11946 - rspadd <string>
11947 - rspdel <search>
11948 - rspidel <search>
11949 - rspdeny <search>
11950 - rspideny <search>
11951 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11952 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11953
11954With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11955is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11956parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11957prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11958Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11959
11960 \t for a tab
11961 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11962 \n for a new line (LF)
11963 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11964 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11965 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11966 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11967 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11968
11969The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11970portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11971above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11972regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
119739 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11974is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11975
11976The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11977after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11978
11979Notes related to these keywords :
11980---------------------------------
11981 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11982 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11983 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11984
11985 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11986 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11987 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11988
11989 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11990 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11991 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11992 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11993 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11994
11995 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11996 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11997 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11998 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11999 useless headers before adding new ones.
12000
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012001 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012002 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12003
12004 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12005 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12006 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12007
12008 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12009 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012010 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012011
12012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120137. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12014----------------------------------
12015
12016Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
12017client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12018The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12019these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12020but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12021data called patterns.
12022
12023
120247.1. ACL basics
12025---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012026
12027The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12028content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12029from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12030simple :
12031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012032 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012033 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012034 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12035 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012037The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12038adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012039
12040In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012042 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012043
12044This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12045Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12046and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012047an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12048conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12049as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12050are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012051
12052ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12053'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12054which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12055
12056There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12057performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012059The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12060specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12061this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012062methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12063ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012064
12065Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12066 - boolean
12067 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12068 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12069 - string
12070 - data block
12071
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012072Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12073converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12074would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12075The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12076which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12077
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012078Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12079keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12080fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12081which are summarized in the table below :
12082
12083 +---------------------+-----------------+
12084 | Sample or converter | Default |
12085 | output type | matching method |
12086 +---------------------+-----------------+
12087 | boolean | bool |
12088 +---------------------+-----------------+
12089 | integer | int |
12090 +---------------------+-----------------+
12091 | ip | ip |
12092 +---------------------+-----------------+
12093 | string | str |
12094 +---------------------+-----------------+
12095 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12096 +---------------------+-----------------+
12097
12098Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12099matching method, see below.
12100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012101The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12102 - boolean
12103 - integer or integer range
12104 - IP address / network
12105 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12106 - regular expression
12107 - hex block
12108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012109The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12110
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012111 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12112 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012113 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012114 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012115 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012116 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012117 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012119The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12120read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12121if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12122lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12123will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12124beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12125a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12126lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12127exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12128
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012129The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12130parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12131ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12132a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12133check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12134
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012135The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12136socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12137file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012139Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12140loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12141
12142 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12143
12144In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12145the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12146case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12147as well.
12148
12149The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12150sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12151do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12152methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12153is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
12154obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
12155followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12156default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12157that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12158string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12159
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012160The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12161By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12162string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12163resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12164server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12165waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12166flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12167function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012169There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12170sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12171be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012172
12173 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12174 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012175 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12176 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12177 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12178 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012179
12180 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12181 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012182 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012183
12184 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012185 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012186
12187 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012188 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012189
12190 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
12191 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12192
12193 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12194 binary or string samples.
12195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012196 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12197 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012199 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12200 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12201 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012203 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12204 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012206 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12207 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012209 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12210 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012212 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12213 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012214 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012216 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12217 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12218 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012219
12220For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12221request, it is possible to do :
12222
12223 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12224
12225In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12226buffer, one would use the following acl :
12227
12228 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12229
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012230On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12231possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12232
12233 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012235All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12236criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12237method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12238to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12239criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12240the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012242If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012243the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12244For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012246 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12247 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12248 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12249 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012250
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012251
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012252The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12253types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12254combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12255brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12256default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012258 +-------------------------------------------------+
12259 | Input sample type |
12260 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012261 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012262 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12263 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12264 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012265 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012266 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012267 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012268 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012269 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012270 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012271 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012272 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012273 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012274 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012275 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012276 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012277 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012278 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012279 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012280 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012281 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012282 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012283 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012284 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012285 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012286 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12287 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12288 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012289
12290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122917.1.1. Matching booleans
12292------------------------
12293
12294In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12295Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12296When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12297that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12298
12299Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12300return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12301"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12302
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123047.1.2. Matching integers
12305------------------------
12306
12307Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12308enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12309to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12310
12311Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12312matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12313lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012314
12315For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12316unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12317representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12318
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012319As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12320two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12321instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12322ranges and operators.
12323
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012324For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012325operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12326Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12327of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012328
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012329Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012330
12331 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12332 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12333 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12334 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12335 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12336
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012337For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012338
12339 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12340
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012341This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12342
12343 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12344
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123467.1.3. Matching strings
12347-----------------------
12348
12349String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12350different forms :
12351
12352 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12353 patterns ;
12354
12355 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12356 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12357
12358 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12359 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12360
12361 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12362 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12363
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012364 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012365 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12366 matches.
12367
12368 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12369 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12370 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012371
12372String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12373exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12374characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12375string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12376to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012377before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012378
12379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12381---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012382
12383Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12384they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12385possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12386passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12387the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012388the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12389match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012390
12391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123927.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12393-------------------------------------
12394
12395It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12396not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12397a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12398to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12399digits may be used upper or lower case.
12400
12401Example :
12402 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12403 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12404
12405
124067.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12407---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012408
12409IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12410netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12411within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012412host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012413difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12414at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12415does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12416parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012417
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012418The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12419abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12420
12421 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12422 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12423 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12424 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12425 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12426 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12427 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12428 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12429
12430Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12431192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12432
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012433IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12434Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12435trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12436IPv6 patterns.
12437
12438HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12439following situations :
12440 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12441 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12442 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12443 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12444 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12445 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12446 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12447 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12448 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12449 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012451
124527.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12453----------------------------------
12454
12455Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12456combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12457
12458 - AND (implicit)
12459 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12460 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012462A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012464 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012466Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12467indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012469For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12470"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12471requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12472is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12473
12474 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012475 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12476 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12477 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012478
12479To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12480and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12481
12482 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12483 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12484 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12485 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12486
12487 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12488 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12489 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12490 use_backend www if host_www
12491
12492It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12493expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12494be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12495the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12496
12497 The following rule :
12498
12499 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012500 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012501
12502 Can also be written that way :
12503
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012504 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012505
12506It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12507to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12508simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12509sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12510good use is the following :
12511
12512 With named ACLs :
12513
12514 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12515 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12516 monitor fail if site_dead
12517
12518 With anonymous ACLs :
12519
12520 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12521
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012522See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12523keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012524
12525
125267.3. Fetching samples
12527---------------------
12528
12529Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12530against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12531sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12532ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12533of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12534available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12535
12536This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12537Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12538compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12539deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12540
12541The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12542matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12543method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12544indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12545
12546As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12547when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12548mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12549the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12550ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12551
12552Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12553multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12554when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12555incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12556are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12557is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12558all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12559
12560Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12561 - name
12562 - name(arg1)
12563 - name(arg1,arg2)
12564
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012565
125667.3.1. Converters
12567-----------------
12568
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012569Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12570of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12571is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12572was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12573has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12574unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12575
12576These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12577sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12578the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12579support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012580
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012581A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12582support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12583supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12584(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12585bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012587The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012588
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001258951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12590 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12591 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12592 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12593 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12594 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12595
12596 Example :
12597 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12598 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12599 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12600 frontend http-in
12601 bind *:8081
12602 default_backend servers
12603 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12604 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12605
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012606add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012607 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012608 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012609 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12610 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012611 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012612 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12613 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12614 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12615 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12616 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012617 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012618
12619and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012620 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012621 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012622 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12623 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012624 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012625 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12626 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12627 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12628 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12629 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012630 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012631
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012632b64dec
12633 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12634 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12635
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012636base64
12637 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12638 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12639 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12640
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012641bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012642 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012643 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12644 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12645 presence of a flag).
12646
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012647bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12648 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12649 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012650 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012651
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012652cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012653 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12654 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012655
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012656crc32([<avalanche>])
12657 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12658 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12659 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12660 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12661 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12662 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12663 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12664 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12665 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12666 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12667 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12668
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012669da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012670 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12671 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12672 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12673 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012674 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012675 configuration language.
12676
12677 Example:
12678 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012679 bind *:8881
12680 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012681 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012682
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012683debug
12684 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12685 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12686 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12687
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012688div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012689 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12690 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012691 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012692 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12693 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012694 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012695 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12696 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12697 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12698 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12699 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012700 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012701
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012702djb2([<avalanche>])
12703 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12704 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12705 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12706 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12707 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12708 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12709 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012710 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12711 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012712
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012713even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012714 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012715 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12716
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012717field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12718 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12719 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12720 list of chars.
12721
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012722hex
12723 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12724 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12725 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12726 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012727
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020012728hex2i
12729 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
12730 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
12731
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012732http_date([<offset>])
12733 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12734 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12735 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12736 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12737 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12738 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012739
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012740in_table(<table>)
12741 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12742 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12743 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12744 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12745 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12746
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012747ipmask(<mask>)
12748 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12749 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12750 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12751 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12752
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012753json([<input-code>])
12754 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12755 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012756 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012757 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12758 of errors:
12759 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12760 bytes, ...)
12761 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12762 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12763
12764 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12765 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12766 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12767 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12768 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12769 are :
12770 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12771 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12772 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12773 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12774 error ;
12775 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12776 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12777
12778 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12779 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12780
12781 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012782 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012783 capture request header user-agent len 150
12784 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012785
12786 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12787 GET / HTTP/1.0
12788 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12789
12790 Output log:
12791 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12792
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012793language(<value>[,<default>])
12794 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12795 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12796 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12797 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12798 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12799 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12800 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12801 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12802 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12803 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12804 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12805 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012806
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012807 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012808
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012809 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12810 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012811
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012812 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12813 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12814 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12815 use_backend spanish if es
12816 use_backend french if fr
12817 use_backend english if en
12818 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012819
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012820lower
12821 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12822 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12823 type. The result is of type string.
12824
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012825ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12826 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12827 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12828 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12829 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12830 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12831 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12832
12833 Example :
12834
12835 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12836 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12837 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12838
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012839map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12840map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12841map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12842 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12843 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12844 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12845 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12846 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12847 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12848 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12849 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012850
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012851 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12852 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12853 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012854
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012855 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012856 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012857
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012858 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12859 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12860 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12861 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012862 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12863 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012864 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12865 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12866 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12867 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12868 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12869 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12870 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12871 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012872 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12873 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12874 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012875 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12876 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12877 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12878 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12879 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012880
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012881 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12882 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12883 the corresponding match text.
12884
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012885 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12886 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12887 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12888 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12889 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012890
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012891 Example :
12892
12893 # this is a comment and is ignored
12894 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12895 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12896 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12897 | | | `---------- value
12898 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12899 | `---------------------------- key
12900 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12901
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012902mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012903 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12904 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012905 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012906 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012907 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012908 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12909 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12910 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12911 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12912 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012913 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012914
12915mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012916 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012917 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12918 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012919 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012920 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012921 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012922 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12923 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12924 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12925 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12926 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012927 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012928
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012929nbsrv
12930 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12931 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12932 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12933 map lookup.
12934
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012935neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012936 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12937 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12938 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12939 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012940
12941not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012942 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012943 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12944 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12945 absence of a flag).
12946
12947odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012948 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012949 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12950
12951or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012952 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012953 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012954 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12955 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012956 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012957 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12958 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12959 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12960 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12961 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012962 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012963
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012964regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012965 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12966 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12967 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12968 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12969 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12970 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12971 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12972 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12973 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12974 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012975 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12976 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12977 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12978 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012979
12980 Example :
12981
12982 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12983 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12984 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12985 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12986
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012987capture-req(<id>)
12988 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12989 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12990
12991 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012992 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12993 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012994
12995capture-res(<id>)
12996 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12997 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12998
12999 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013000 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13001 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013002
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013003sdbm([<avalanche>])
13004 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13005 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13006 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13007 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13008 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13009 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13010 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013011 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
13012 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013013
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013014set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013015 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
13016 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
13017 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013018 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013019 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13020 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013021 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013022 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13023 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013024 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013025 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013026
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013027sha1
13028 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13029 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13030
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013031sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013032 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13033 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013034 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013035 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13036 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013037 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013038 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13039 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013040 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013041 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13042 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013043 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013044 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013045
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013046table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13047 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13048 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13049 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13050 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13051 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13052 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13053
13054
13055table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13056 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13057 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13058 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13059 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13060 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13061 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13062
13063table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13064 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13065 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13066 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13067 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13068 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13069
13070table_conn_cur(<table>)
13071 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13072 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13073 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13074 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13075 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13076
13077table_conn_rate(<table>)
13078 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13079 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13080 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13081 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13082 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13083
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013084table_gpt0(<table>)
13085 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13086 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13087 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13088 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13089 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13090
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013091table_gpc0(<table>)
13092 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13093 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13094 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13095 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13096 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13097
13098table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13099 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13100 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13101 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13102 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13103 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13104 sample fetch keyword.
13105
13106table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13107 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13108 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13109 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13110 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13111 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13112
13113table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13114 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13115 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13116 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13117 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13118 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13119 keyword.
13120
13121table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13122 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13123 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13124 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13125 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13126 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13127
13128table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13129 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13130 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13131 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13132 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13133 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13134 keyword.
13135
13136table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13137 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13138 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13139 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
13140 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13141 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13142 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13143 keyword.
13144
13145table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13146 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13147 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13148 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
13149 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13150 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13151 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13152 keyword.
13153
13154table_server_id(<table>)
13155 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13156 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13157 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13158 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13159 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13160 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13161
13162table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13163 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13164 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13165 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13166 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13167 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13168 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13169 keyword.
13170
13171table_sess_rate(<table>)
13172 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13173 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13174 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13175 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13176 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13177 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13178 keyword.
13179
13180table_trackers(<table>)
13181 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13182 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13183 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13184 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13185 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13186 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13187 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13188 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13189 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13190 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13191
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013192upper
13193 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13194 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13195 type. The result is of type string.
13196
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013197url_dec
13198 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13199 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13200
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013201unset-var(<var name>)
13202 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13203 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13204 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13205 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13206 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13207 response),
13208 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13209 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13210 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13211 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13212
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013213utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13214 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13215 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13216 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13217 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13218 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13219 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13220
13221 Example :
13222
13223 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
13224 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
13225 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13226
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013227word(<index>,<delimiters>)
13228 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
13229 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13230
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013231wt6([<avalanche>])
13232 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13233 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13234 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13235 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13236 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13237 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13238 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013239 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13240 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013241
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013242xor(<value>)
13243 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013244 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013245 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013246 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013247 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013248 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13249 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013250 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013251 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13252 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013253 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013254 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013255
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013256xxh32([<seed>])
13257 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13258 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13259 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13260 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13261 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13262 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13263 as cryptographically secure.
13264
13265xxh64([<seed>])
13266 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13267 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13268 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13269 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13270 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13271 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13272 as cryptographically secure.
13273
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013274
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200132757.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013276--------------------------------------------
13277
13278A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13279not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13280"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13281The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13282
13283always_false : boolean
13284 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13285 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13286
13287always_true : boolean
13288 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13289 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13290
13291avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013292 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013293 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13294 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13295 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13296 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13297 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13298 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13299 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13300 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13301 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13302 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13303 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13304 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13305 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013307be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013308 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13309 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13310 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13311 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13312 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013314be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13315 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13316 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13317 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13318 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13319 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13320 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013321
13322 Example :
13323 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13324 backend dynamic
13325 mode http
13326 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13327 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013328
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013329bin(<hexa>) : bin
13330 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13331 of the string.
13332
13333bool(<bool>) : bool
13334 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13335 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013337connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13338 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013339 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013340 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13341 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013342
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013343 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013344 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013345 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13346
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013347 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13348 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013349
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013350 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013351 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013352 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013353 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13354 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013355 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013356 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013357
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013358 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13359 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013360 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013361 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013362
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013363date([<offset>]) : integer
13364 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13365 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13366 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13367 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013368 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13369
13370 Example :
13371
13372 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13373 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013374
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013375distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13376 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13377 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13378 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13379 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13380 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13381 list of supported tokens.
13382
13383distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13384 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13385 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13386 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13387 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13388 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13389 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13390 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13391 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13392 supported tokens.
13393
13394 Example :
13395 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13396 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13397 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13398 # send large files to the big farm
13399 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13400
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013401env(<name>) : string
13402 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13403 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13404 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13405 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13406 certain way.
13407
13408 Examples :
13409 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13410 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13411
13412 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13413 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013415fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13416 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013417 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13418 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013419 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13420 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13421 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13422 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13423 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013424
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013425fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13426 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13427 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13428 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013430fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13431 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13432 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13433 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13434 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13435 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13436 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13437 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13438 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013439
13440 Example :
13441 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13442 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13443 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13444 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13445 frontend mail
13446 bind :25
13447 mode tcp
13448 maxconn 100
13449 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13450 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13451 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13452 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013453
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013454hostname : string
13455 Returns the system hostname.
13456
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013457int(<integer>) : signed integer
13458 Returns a signed integer.
13459
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013460ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13461 Returns an ipv4.
13462
13463ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13464 Returns an ipv6.
13465
13466meth(<method>) : method
13467 Returns a method.
13468
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013469nbproc : integer
13470 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13471 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13472 and debugging purposes.
13473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013474nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13475 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13476 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13477 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013478 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13479 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13480 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013481
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013482proc : integer
13483 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13484 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13485 debugging purposes.
13486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013487queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013488 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13489 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13490 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013491 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13492 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13493 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13494 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13495 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13496
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013497rand([<range>]) : integer
13498 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13499 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13500 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13501 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13502 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013504srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13505 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13506 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13507 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13508 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13509 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13510 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13511 methods.
13512
13513srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13514 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13515 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13516 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13517 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13518 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13519 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13520 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13521
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013522srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13523 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
13524 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13525 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
13526 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
13527 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
13528 fetch methods.
13529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013530srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13531 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13532 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013533 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013534 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13535 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13536 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13537 overloading servers).
13538
13539 Example :
13540 # Redirect to a separate back
13541 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13542 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13543 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13544
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013545stopping : boolean
13546 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13547 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13548 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13549
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013550str(<string>) : string
13551 Returns a string.
13552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013553table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13554 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13555 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13556
13557table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13558 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13559 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13560 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13561
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013562var(<var-name>) : undefined
13563 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013564 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13565 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013566 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013567 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13568 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013569 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013570 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13571 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013572 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013573 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013574
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200135757.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013576----------------------------------
13577
13578The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13579closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13580methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13581sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13582TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013583the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13584counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13585"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013586argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13587the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13588this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013589
13590be_id : integer
13591 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13592 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13593
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013594be_name : string
13595 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13596 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013598dst : ip
13599 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13600 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13601 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13602 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13603 RFC 4291.
13604
13605dst_conn : integer
13606 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13607 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13608 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13609 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13610 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13611 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13612 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13613 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013614
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013615dst_is_local : boolean
13616 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13617 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13618 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13619 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13620 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13621 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13622 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13623 it only once per connection.
13624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013625dst_port : integer
13626 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13627 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13628 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13629 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13630 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13631 an HTTP header.
13632
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020013633fc_http_major : integer
13634 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
13635 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
13636 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
13637
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013638fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13639 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13640 header.
13641
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013642fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13643 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13644 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13645 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13646 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13647 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13648 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13649
13650fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13651 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13652 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13653 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13654 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13655 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13656 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13657
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013658fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13659 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13660 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13661 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13662 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13663
13664fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13665 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13666 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13667 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13668 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13669
13670fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13671 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13672 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13673 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13674 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13675
13676fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13677 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13678 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13679 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13680 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13681
13682fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13683 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13684 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13685 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13686 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13687
13688fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13689 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13690 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13691 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13692 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013694fe_id : integer
13695 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013696 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013697 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13698
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013699fe_name : string
13700 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13701 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13702 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13703
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013704sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013705sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13706sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13707sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013708 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13709 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13710 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13711
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013712sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013713sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13714sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13715sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013716 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13717 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13718 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13719
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013720sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013721sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13722sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13723sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013724 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13725 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013726 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13727 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13728 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013729
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013730 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013731 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13732 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013733 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13734 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13735 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013736 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13737 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13738
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013739sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013740sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13741sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13742sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013743 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13744 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13745
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013746sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013747sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13748sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13749sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013750 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13751 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13752 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13753
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013754sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013755sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13756sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13757sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013758 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13759 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13760 See also src_conn_rate.
13761
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013762sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013763sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13764sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13765sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013766 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013767 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013768
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013769sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13770sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13771sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13772sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13773 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13774 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13775
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013776sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013777sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13778sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13779sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013780 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13781 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13782 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013783 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13784 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13785 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013786
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013787sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013788sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13789sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13790sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013791 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13792 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13793 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13794
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013795sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013796sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13797sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13798sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013799 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13800 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13801 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13802 src_http_err_rate.
13803
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013804sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013805sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13806sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13807sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013808 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13809 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13810 src_http_req_cnt.
13811
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013812sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013813sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13814sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13815sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013816 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13817 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13818 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13819 src_http_req_rate.
13820
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013821sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013822sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13823sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13824sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013825 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013826 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13827 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13828 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13829 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013830
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013831 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013832 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13833 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013834 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13835
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013836sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013837sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13838sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13839sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013840 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13841 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13842 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013843
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013844sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013845sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13846sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13847sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013848 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13849 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13850 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013851
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013852sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013853sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13854sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13855sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013856 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13857 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13858 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13859 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013860 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013861 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13862
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013863sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013864sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13865sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13866sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013867 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13868 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13869 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13870 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13871 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013872 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013873
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013874sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013875sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13876sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13877sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013878 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13879 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13880 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13881
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013882sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013883sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13884sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13885sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013886 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13887 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013888 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013889 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13890 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013891 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13892 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13893 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013895so_id : integer
13896 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13897 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13898 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013900src : ip
13901 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13902 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13903 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13904 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013905 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13906 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13907 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13908 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013909
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013910 Example:
13911 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13912 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013914src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13915 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13916 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13917 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013918 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013920src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13921 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13922 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013923 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013924 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013926src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13927 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13928 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13929 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13930 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13931 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13932 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013933
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013934 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013935 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13936 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13937 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13938 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013939 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013940 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13941 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013943src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013944 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013945 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013946 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013947 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013949src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013950 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013951 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13952 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013953 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013955src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13956 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13957 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13958 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013959 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013961src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013962 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013963 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013964 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013965 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013966
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013967src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13968 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13969 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13970 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13971 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013973src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013974 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013975 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013976 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13977 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013978 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13979 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13980 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013982src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13983 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13984 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013985 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013986 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013987 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013989src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13990 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13991 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13992 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13993 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013994 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013996src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13997 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13998 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13999 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014000 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014002src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14003 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14004 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14005 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014006 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014007 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014009src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14010 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14011 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14012 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014013 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014014 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14015 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014016
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014017 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014018 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014019 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014020 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014021
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014022src_is_local : boolean
14023 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14024 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14025 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14026 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
14027 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
14028 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14029 once per connection.
14030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014031src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014032 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14033 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14034 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14035 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14036 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014038src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014039 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14040 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14041 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14042 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14043 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014045src_port : integer
14046 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14047 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14048 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14049 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014051src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14052 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014053 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14054 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14055 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014056 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014058src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14059 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14060 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14061 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14062 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014063 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014065src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14066 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14067 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14068 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14069 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14070 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14071 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14072 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14073 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014074
14075 Example :
14076 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14077 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14078 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14079 listen ssh
14080 bind :22
14081 mode tcp
14082 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014083 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014084 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014085 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014087srv_id : integer
14088 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14089 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14090 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014091
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140927.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014093----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014095The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14096closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14097when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14098usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014099future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014100
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001410151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14102 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14103 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14104 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14105 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14106 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14107
14108 Example :
14109 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14110 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14111 # the request.
14112 frontend http-in
14113 bind *:8081
14114 default_backend servers
14115 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14116 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14117
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014118ssl_bc : boolean
14119 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14120 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14121 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14122
14123ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14124 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14125 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14126
14127ssl_bc_cipher : string
14128 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14129 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14130
14131ssl_bc_protocol : string
14132 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14133 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14134
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014135ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014136 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014137 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14138 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014139
14140ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14141 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14142 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14143 if session was reused or not.
14144
14145ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14146 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14147 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014149ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14150 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14151 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14152 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14153 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14154 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014156ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14157 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14158 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14159 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14160 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014161
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014162ssl_c_der : binary
14163 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14164 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14165 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014167ssl_c_err : integer
14168 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14169 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14170 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14171 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14172 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014174ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14175 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14176 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14177 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14178 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14179 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14180 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14181 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14182 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014184ssl_c_key_alg : string
14185 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14186 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14187 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014189ssl_c_notafter : string
14190 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14191 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14192 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014194ssl_c_notbefore : string
14195 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14196 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14197 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014199ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14200 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14201 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14202 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14203 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14204 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14205 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14206 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14207 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014209ssl_c_serial : binary
14210 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14211 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14212 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014214ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14215 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14216 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14217 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014218 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14219 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14220
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014221 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014222 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014224ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14225 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14226 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14227 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014229ssl_c_used : boolean
14230 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14231 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014233ssl_c_verify : integer
14234 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14235 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14236 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14237 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014239ssl_c_version : integer
14240 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14241 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014242
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014243ssl_f_der : binary
14244 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14245 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14246 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014248ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14249 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14250 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14251 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14252 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014253 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014254 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14255 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14256 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014258ssl_f_key_alg : string
14259 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14260 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14261 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014263ssl_f_notafter : string
14264 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14265 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14266 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014268ssl_f_notbefore : string
14269 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14270 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14271 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014273ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14274 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14275 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14276 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14277 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14278 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14279 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14280 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14281 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014283ssl_f_serial : binary
14284 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14285 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14286 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014287
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014288ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14289 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14290 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14291 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014293ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14294 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14295 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14296 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014298ssl_f_version : integer
14299 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14300 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14301
14302ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014303 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14304 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14305 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014307 Example :
14308 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14309 listen http-https
14310 bind :80
14311 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14312 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14313
14314ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14315 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14316 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14317
14318ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014319 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014320 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14321 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14322 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14323 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14324 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14325 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14326 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14327 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014329ssl_fc_cipher : string
14330 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14331 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014332
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014333ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14334 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14335 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014336 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014337
14338ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14339 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14340 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014341 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014342
14343ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14344 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14345 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14346 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014347 avaible with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
14348 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014349
14350ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14351 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14352 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014353 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014355ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014356 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14357 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014358 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14359 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14360 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14361 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014362
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014363ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14364 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14365 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14366 wait until the handshake happened.
14367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014368ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14369 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014370 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14371 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14372 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14373 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014374
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014375ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014376 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14377 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014379ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014380 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014381 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14382 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14383 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14384 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14385 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14386 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14387 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014389ssl_fc_protocol : string
14390 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14391 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014392
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014393ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014394 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014395 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14396 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014398ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14399 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14400 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14401 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14402 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014404ssl_fc_sni : string
14405 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14406 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14407 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14408 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14409 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14410
14411 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14412 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14413 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014414 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14415 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014417 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014418 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14419 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014421ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14422 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14423 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014424
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014425
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144267.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014427------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014429Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14430sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14431only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14432For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14433be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14434can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14435sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14436for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14437content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014439payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14440 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14441 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14442 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014444payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14445 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14446 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14447 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014448
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014449req.hdrs : string
14450 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14451 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14452 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14453 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14454
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014455req.hdrs_bin : binary
14456 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14457 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14458 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14459 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14460 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14461 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14462
14463 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14464
14465 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14466 str: <int:length><bytes>
14467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014468req.len : integer
14469req_len : integer (deprecated)
14470 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14471 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14472 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14473 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14474 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14475 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14476 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14477 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014479req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14480 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014481 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14482 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14483 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14484 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014486 ACL alternatives :
14487 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014489req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14490 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14491 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14492 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14493 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014495 ACL alternatives :
14496 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014498 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014500req.proto_http : boolean
14501req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14502 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14503 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14504 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14505 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14506 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14507 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14508 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014510 Example:
14511 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14512 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14513 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014514 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014516req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14517rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14518 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14519 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14520 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14521 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14522 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14523 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14524 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014526 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14527 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14528 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14529 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14530 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14531 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014533 ACL derivatives :
14534 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014536 Example :
14537 listen tse-farm
14538 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14539 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14540 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14541 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14542 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14543 persist rdp-cookie
14544 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14545 # This is only useful makes sense if
14546 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14547 stick-table type string size 204800
14548 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14549 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14550 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014552 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14553 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014555req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14556rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14557 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14558 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14559 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14560 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014562 ACL derivatives :
14563 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014564
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014565req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14566 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14567 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014568 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14569 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14570 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14571 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14572 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014574req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14575req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14576 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14577 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14578 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14579 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14580 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14581 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14582 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014584req.ssl_sni : string
14585req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14586 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14587 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14588 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14589 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14590 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14591 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14592 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14593 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14594 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14595 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14596 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14597 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014599 ACL derivatives :
14600 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014602 Examples :
14603 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14604 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14605 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14606 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14607 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014608
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014609req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14610 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14611 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14612 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14613 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14614 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14615 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14616 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14617 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14618 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014620req.ssl_ver : integer
14621req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14622 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14623 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14624 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14625 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14626 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14627 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14628 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14629 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14630 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014632 ACL derivatives :
14633 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014634
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014635res.len : integer
14636 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14637 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14638 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14639 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14640 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14641 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14642 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14643 content inspection.
14644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014645res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14646 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014647 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14648 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14649 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14650 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014652res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14653 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14654 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14655 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14656 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014658 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014659
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014660res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14661rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14662 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14663 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14664 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14665 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14666 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14667 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14668 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014670wait_end : boolean
14671 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14672 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14673 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14674 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14675 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14676 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14677 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14678 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014680 Examples :
14681 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14682 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14683 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014685 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14686 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14687 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14688 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14689 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14690 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14691 tcp-request content reject
14692
14693
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146947.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014695--------------------------------------
14696
14697It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14698This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14699data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14700its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14701HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14702content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14703to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14704more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14705response are indexed.
14706
14707base : string
14708 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14709 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14710 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14711 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14712 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14713 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14714 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14715 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14716
14717 ACL derivatives :
14718 base : exact string match
14719 base_beg : prefix match
14720 base_dir : subdir match
14721 base_dom : domain match
14722 base_end : suffix match
14723 base_len : length match
14724 base_reg : regex match
14725 base_sub : substring match
14726
14727base32 : integer
14728 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14729 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14730 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014731 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14732 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14733 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014734
14735base32+src : binary
14736 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14737 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14738 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14739 per-URL counters.
14740
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014741capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14742 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14743 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14744 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14745
14746capture.req.method : string
14747 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14748 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14749 because it's allocated.
14750
14751capture.req.uri : string
14752 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14753 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14754 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14755 allocated.
14756
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014757capture.req.ver : string
14758 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14759 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14760 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14761
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014762capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14763 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14764 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14765 The first entry is an index of 0.
14766 See also: "capture response header"
14767
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014768capture.res.ver : string
14769 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14770 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14771 persistent flag.
14772
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014773req.body : binary
14774 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14775 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14776 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14777 the first chunk is analyzed.
14778
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014779req.body_param([<name>) : string
14780 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14781 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14782 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14783 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14784 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14785 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14786 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14787 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14788 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14789 given.
14790
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014791req.body_len : integer
14792 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14793 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14794 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14795 "option http-buffer-request".
14796
14797req.body_size : integer
14798 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14799 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14800 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14801 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14802 "option http-buffer-request".
14803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804req.cook([<name>]) : string
14805cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14806 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14807 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14808 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14809 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14810 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14811 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14812 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14813 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14814
14815 ACL derivatives :
14816 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14817 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14818 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14819 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14820 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14821 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14822 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14823 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14826cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14827 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14828 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014830req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14831cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14832 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14833 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14834 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14835 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014837cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14838 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14839 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14840 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14841 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014842 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014843 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14844 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14845 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14846 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014848hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14849 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14850 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14851 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14852 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014853 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014855req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14856 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14857 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14858 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14859 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14860 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14861 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14862 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14863 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014865req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14866 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14867 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14868 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14869 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014871req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14872 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14873 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14874 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14875 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14876 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14877 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14878 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14879 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000014880 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014881 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14882 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014884 ACL derivatives :
14885 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14886 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14887 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14888 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14889 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14890 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14891 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14892 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14893
14894req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14895hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14896 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14897 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14898 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14899 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14900 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14901 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14902 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14903 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14904 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14905
14906req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14907hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14908 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14909 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14910 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14911 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14912 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14913 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14914 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14915 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14916
14917req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14918hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14919 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14920 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14921 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14922 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14923 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14924 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14925 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14926
14927http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14928 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14929 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14930 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14931 basic auth is supported.
14932
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014933http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14934 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14935 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14936 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14937 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014938 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14939 basic auth is supported.
14940
14941 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014942 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14943 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14944 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14945 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014946
14947http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014948 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14949 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014950 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14951 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014953method : integer + string
14954 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14955 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14956 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14957 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14958 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14959 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14960 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014962 ACL derivatives :
14963 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014965 Example :
14966 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14967 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14968 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014970path : string
14971 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14972 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14973 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14974 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14975 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14976 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14977 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014979 ACL derivatives :
14980 path : exact string match
14981 path_beg : prefix match
14982 path_dir : subdir match
14983 path_dom : domain match
14984 path_end : suffix match
14985 path_len : length match
14986 path_reg : regex match
14987 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014988
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014989query : string
14990 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14991 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14992 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14993 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014994 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014995 which stops before the question mark.
14996
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014997req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14998 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14999 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15000 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15001 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015003req.ver : string
15004req_ver : string (deprecated)
15005 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15006 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15007 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015009 ACL derivatives :
15010 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015012res.comp : boolean
15013 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15014 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15015 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015017res.comp_algo : string
15018 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15019 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15020 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015022res.cook([<name>]) : string
15023scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15024 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15025 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15026 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015028 ACL derivatives :
15029 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015031res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15032scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15033 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15034 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15035 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015037res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15038scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15039 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15040 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15041 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015043res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15044 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15045 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15046 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15047 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15048 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15049 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15050 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15051 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15052 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015054res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15055 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15056 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15057 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15058 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15059 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015061res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15062shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15063 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15064 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15065 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15066 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15067 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15068 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15069 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15070 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015072 ACL derivatives :
15073 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15074 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15075 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15076 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15077 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15078 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15079 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15080 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15081
15082res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15083shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15084 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15085 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15086 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15087 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15088 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015090res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15091shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15092 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15093 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15094 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15095 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15096 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15097 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015098
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015099res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15100 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15101 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15102 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15103 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015105res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15106shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15107 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15108 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15109 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15110 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15111 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15112 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015114res.ver : string
15115resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15116 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15117 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015119 ACL derivatives :
15120 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015122set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15123 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15124 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015125 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015126 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015128 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15129 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015131status : integer
15132 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15133 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15134 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015135
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015136unique-id : string
15137 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15138 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15139 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15140 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15141 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15142 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015144url : string
15145 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15146 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15147 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15148 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15149 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15150 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15151 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015153 ACL derivatives :
15154 url : exact string match
15155 url_beg : prefix match
15156 url_dir : subdir match
15157 url_dom : domain match
15158 url_end : suffix match
15159 url_len : length match
15160 url_reg : regex match
15161 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015163url_ip : ip
15164 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15165 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15166 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15167 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15168 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15169 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15170 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015172url_port : integer
15173 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15174 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15175 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15176 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015177
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015178urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15179url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015180 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15181 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015182 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15183 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15184 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15185 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015186 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15187 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015188 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15189 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015191 ACL derivatives :
15192 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15193 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15194 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15195 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15196 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15197 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15198 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15199 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015200
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015202 Example :
15203 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15204 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15205 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15206 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015207
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015208urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015209 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15210 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15211 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015212
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015213url32 : integer
15214 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15215 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15216 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15217 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15218 is an unsigned integer.
15219
15220url32+src : binary
15221 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15222 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15223 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15224
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200152267.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015227---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015229Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15230every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015231order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015233ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15234---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015235FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015236HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015237HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15238HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015239HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15240HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15241HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15242HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15243LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015244METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015245METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015246METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15247METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15248METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15249METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015250METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015251METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015252RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015253REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015254TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015255WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15256---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015257
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152598. Logging
15260----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015261
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015262One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15263provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15264very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15265provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15266state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015267to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015268headers.
15269
15270In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15271about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15272send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15273
15274 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15275 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15276 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15277 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15278 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015279 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
15280 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015281
15282The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15283allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15284as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15285while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15286real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15287delay.
15288
15289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152908.1. Log levels
15291---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015292
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015293TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015294source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015295HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15296in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15297track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15298syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15299about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015300
15301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153028.2. Log formats
15303----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015304
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015305HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015306and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15307slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15308options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015309
15310 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15311 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15312 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15313 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15314 extents.
15315
15316 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15317 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15318 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15319 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15320 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15321
15322 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15323 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15324 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15325 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15326 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15327
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015328 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15329 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15330 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15331 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15332
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015333 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15334
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015335Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15336specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15337field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15338servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15339always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15340identifier.
15341
15342Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15343 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15344 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15345 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15346 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15347
15348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153498.2.1. Default log format
15350-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015351
15352This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15353as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15354format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15355
15356 Example :
15357 listen www
15358 mode http
15359 log global
15360 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15361
15362 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15363 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15364 (www/HTTP)
15365
15366 Field Format Extract from the example above
15367 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15368 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15369 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15370 4 'to' to
15371 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15372 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15373
15374Detailed fields description :
15375 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15376 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15377 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15378 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15379 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15380 and processed the connection.
15381 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15382
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015383In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15384"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15385connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15386
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015387It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15388will eventually disappear.
15389
15390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153918.2.2. TCP log format
15392---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015393
15394The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15395is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15396information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15397counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15398emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15399environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15400the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15401sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015402specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15403not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15404fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15405marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015406
15407 Example :
15408 frontend fnt
15409 mode tcp
15410 option tcplog
15411 log global
15412 default_backend bck
15413
15414 backend bck
15415 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15416
15417 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15418 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15419 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15420
15421 Field Format Extract from the example above
15422 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15423 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15424 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15425 4 frontend_name fnt
15426 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15427 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15428 7 bytes_read* 212
15429 8 termination_state --
15430 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15431 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15432
15433Detailed fields description :
15434 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015435 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15436 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15437 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015438 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15439 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15440 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015441
15442 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015443 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15444 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15445 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015446
15447 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15448 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15449 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15450 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15451
15452 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15453 and processed the connection.
15454
15455 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15456 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15457 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15458 applications.
15459
15460 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15461 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15462 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15463 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15464 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15465
15466 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15467 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15468 See "Timers" below for more details.
15469
15470 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15471 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15472 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15473 "Timers" below for more details.
15474
15475 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015476 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015477 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15478 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15479 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15480 details.
15481
15482 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15483 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15484 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15485 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15486 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15487
15488 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15489 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15490 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15491 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15492 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15493 for more details.
15494
15495 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015496 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015497 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15498 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15499 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015500 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015501
15502 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15503 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15504 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15505 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15506 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15507 caused by a denial of service attack.
15508
15509 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15510 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15511 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15512 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15513 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15514 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15515 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15516 denial of service attack.
15517
15518 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15519 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15520 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15521 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15522 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15523 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15524 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15525 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15526 be processed than on other servers.
15527
15528 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15529 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15530 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15531 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15532 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15533 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15534 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15535 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15536 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15537 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15538 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15539 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15540 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15541
15542 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15543 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15544 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15545 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15546 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15547 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15548 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15549 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15550
15551 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15552 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15553 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15554 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15555 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15556 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15557 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15558 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15559 occurs.
15560
15561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155628.2.3. HTTP log format
15563----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015564
15565The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15566is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15567the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15568are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15569emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15570generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15571"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15572which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015573frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15574is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015575
15576Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15577slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15578with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15579
15580 Example :
15581 frontend http-in
15582 mode http
15583 option httplog
15584 log global
15585 default_backend bck
15586
15587 backend static
15588 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15589
15590 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15591 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15592 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015593 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015594
15595 Field Format Extract from the example above
15596 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15597 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015598 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015599 4 frontend_name http-in
15600 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015601 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015602 7 status_code 200
15603 8 bytes_read* 2750
15604 9 captured_request_cookie -
15605 10 captured_response_cookie -
15606 11 termination_state ----
15607 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15608 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15609 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15610 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15611 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015612
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015613Detailed fields description :
15614 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015615 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15616 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15617 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015618 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15619 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15620 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015621
15622 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015623 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15624 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15625 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015626
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015627 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15628 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015629
15630 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15631 and processed the connection.
15632
15633 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15634 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15635 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15636
15637 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15638 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15639 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15640 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15641 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15642 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15643
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015644 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15645 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15646 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15647 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15648 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15649 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15650 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015651
15652 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15653 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15654 See "Timers" below for more details.
15655
15656 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15657 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15658 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15659 below for more details.
15660
15661 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15662 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15663 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15664 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15665 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15666 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15667 for more details.
15668
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015669 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15670 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15671 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15672 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15673 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15674 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15675 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15676 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015677
15678 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15679 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15680 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15681
15682 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15683 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15684 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15685 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15686 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15687 overflowing.
15688
15689 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15690 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15691 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15692 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15693 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15694 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15695 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15696 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15697
15698 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15699 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15700 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15701 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15702 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15703 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15704 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15705 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15706
15707 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15708 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15709 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15710 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15711 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15712 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15713 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15714
15715 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015716 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015717 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15718 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15719 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015720 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015721 system.
15722
15723 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15724 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15725 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15726 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15727 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15728 caused by a denial of service attack.
15729
15730 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15731 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15732 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15733 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15734 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15735 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15736 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15737 denial of service attack.
15738
15739 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15740 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15741 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15742 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15743 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15744 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15745 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15746 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15747 processed than on other servers.
15748
15749 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15750 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15751 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15752 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15753 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15754 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15755 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15756 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15757 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15758 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15759 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15760 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15761 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15762
15763 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15764 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15765 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15766 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15767 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15768 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15769 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15770 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15771
15772 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15773 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15774 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15775 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15776 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15777 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15778 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15779 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15780 occurs.
15781
15782 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15783 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15784 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15785 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15786 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15787 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15788 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15789 cookies" below for more details.
15790
15791 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15792 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15793 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15794 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15795 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15796 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15797 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15798 and cookies" below for more details.
15799
15800 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15801 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15802 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15803 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15804 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15805 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15806 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15807 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15808
15809
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200158108.2.4. Custom log format
15811------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015812
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015813The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015814mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015815
15816HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15817Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15818separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15819prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15820
15821Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15822variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015823("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015824
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015825If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015826as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015827less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15828the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15829
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015830Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015831In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015832in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015833
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015834Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15835'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15836https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15837such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15838
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015839Flags are :
15840 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015841 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015842 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15843 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015844
15845 Example:
15846
15847 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15848 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15849
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015850 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15851
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015852At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15853
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015854 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15855 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015856
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015857the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015858
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015859 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15860 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15861 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015862
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015863and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15864
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015865 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15866 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015867
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015868Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15869
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015870 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015871 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015872 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15873 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15874 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015875 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15876 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15877 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015878 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015879 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15880 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015881 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015882 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15883 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015884 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015885 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015886 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015887 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015888 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015889 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015890 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015891 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15892 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15893 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15894 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15895 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015896 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015897 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15898 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015899 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015900 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15901 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015902 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15903 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15904 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015905 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015906 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15907 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015908 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015909 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15910 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15911 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015912 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015913 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015914 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15915 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15916 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15917 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015918 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015919 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015920 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015921 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015922 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015923 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015924 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15925 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15926 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015927 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015928 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15929 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015930 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015931 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15932 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15933 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015934 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015935 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015936 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015937
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015938 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015939
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015940
159418.2.5. Error log format
15942-----------------------
15943
15944When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15945protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15946By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15947"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15948will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15949logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15950
15951The format looks like this :
15952
15953 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15954 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15955 Connection error during SSL handshake
15956
15957 Field Format Extract from the example above
15958 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15959 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15960 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15961 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15962 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15963
15964These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15965failures.
15966
15967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159688.3. Advanced logging options
15969-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015970
15971Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15972just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15973options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15974for more information about their usage.
15975
15976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159778.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15978------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015979
15980It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15981haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15982commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15983monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15984ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15985
15986 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15987 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15988 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15989 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15990
15991 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15992 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15993 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015994 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015995 such as other load-balancers.
15996
15997 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15998 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15999 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16000
16001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160028.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16003----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016004
16005The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16006what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16007or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
16008"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
16009just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16010log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16011after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16012is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16013with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16014with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16015
16016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160178.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16018------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016019
16020Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16021for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16022"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16023retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16024raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16025a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16026file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16027you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16028"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16029
16030
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160318.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16032--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016033
16034Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16035multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16036them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16037"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16038logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16039error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16040and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16041too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16042useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16043alternative.
16044
16045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160468.4. Timing events
16047------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016048
16049Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16050reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16051the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16052frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016053mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16054addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16055
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016056Timings events in HTTP mode:
16057
16058 first request 2nd request
16059 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16060 t tr t tr ...
16061 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16062 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16063 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16064 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16065 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16066
16067Timings events in TCP mode:
16068
16069 TCP session
16070 |<----------------->|
16071 t t
16072 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16073 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16074 |<------ Tt ------->|
16075
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016076 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
16077 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
16078 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16079 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16080 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
16081 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
16082 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016083
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016084 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16085 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16086 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
16087 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
16088 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
16089 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
16090 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
16091 nothing was received on the connection.
16092
16093 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16094 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16095 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16096 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16097 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16098 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16099 request typed by hand during a test.
16100
16101 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16102 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
16103 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
16104 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16105 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16106 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16107 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016108
16109 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16110 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16111 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16112 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16113 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16114
16115 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16116 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16117 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16118 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16119 connection never established.
16120
16121 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16122 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16123 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16124 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16125 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16126 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16127 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16128 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16129 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16130 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16131 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16132
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016133 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16134 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16135 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16136 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16137 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16138 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16139
16140 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16141
16142 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16143 "Ta" can never be negative.
16144
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016145 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16146 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016147 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16148 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016149 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016150
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016151 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016152
16153 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016154 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16155 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016156
16157These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16158protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16159that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016160due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16161"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16162that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016163
16164Most common cases :
16165
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016166 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16167 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16168 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16169 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16170 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16171 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16172 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16173 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16174 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16175 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16176 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016177 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016178
16179 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16180 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16181 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16182 of ms on remote networks.
16183
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016184 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16185 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16186 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016187
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016188 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16189 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16190 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16191 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16192 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16193 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16194 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16195 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16196 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016197
16198Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16199
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016200 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016201 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016202 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016203
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016204 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016205 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16206 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16207
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016208 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016209 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16210 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16211 flags.
16212
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016213 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16214 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016215 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16216 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16217 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16218 the client connection was maintained open.
16219
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016220 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016221 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016222 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016223 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16224
16225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162268.5. Session state at disconnection
16227-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016228
16229TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16230"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
162312-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16232each of which has a special meaning :
16233
16234 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16235 session to terminate :
16236
16237 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16238
16239 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16240 server explicitly refused it.
16241
16242 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16243 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16244 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16245 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016246 (eg: cacheable cookie).
16247
16248 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16249 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016250
16251 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16252 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16253 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16254 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16255 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16256
16257 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16258 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16259 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16260 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16261 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16262
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016263 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16264 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16265
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016266 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16267 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16268 backup connections when going up.
16269
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016270 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16271
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016272 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16273 send or receive data.
16274
16275 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16276 send or receive data.
16277
16278 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16279 with nothing left in the buffers.
16280
16281 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16282
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016283 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016284 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16285
16286 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16287 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16288 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16289 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16290 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16291
16292 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16293 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16294
16295 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16296 server (HTTP only).
16297
16298 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16299
16300 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16301 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16302 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16303
16304 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16305 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16306 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16307
16308 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16309
16310 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16311 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16312
16313 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16314 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16315 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16316
16317 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16318 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016319 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16320 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016321
16322 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16323 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16324 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16325 another server.
16326
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016327 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016328 server.
16329
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016330 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16331 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16332 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16333 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16334
16335 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16336 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16337 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16338 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16339
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016340 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16341 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16342 "use-server" rule).
16343
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016344 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16345
16346 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16347 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16348
16349 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16350
16351 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16352 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16353 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16354
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016355 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16356 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016357 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016358 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16359 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16360
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016361 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16362
16363 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16364 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16365
16366 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16367
16368 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16369
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016370The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16371was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016372helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16373starvation, attacks, etc...
16374
16375The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16376alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16377easier finding and understanding.
16378
16379 Flags Reason
16380
16381 -- Normal termination.
16382
16383 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16384 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16385 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16386 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16387
16388 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16389 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16390 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16391 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16392 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16393 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016394
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016395 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16396 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016397 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016398
16399 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16400 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16401 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16402
16403 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16404 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16405 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16406 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16407 the server takes too long to respond.
16408
16409 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16410 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16411 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16412 long a time to respond.
16413
16414 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16415 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16416 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16417 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016418 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16419 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016420
16421 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16422 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16423 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16424 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16425 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016426 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016427 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16428 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16429 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16430 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16431 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16432 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16433 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16434 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16435 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16436 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16437 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16438 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016439
16440 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16441 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016442 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16443 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16444 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16445 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016446
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016447 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16448 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016450 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016451 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16452 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16453 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16454 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16455 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16456
16457 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16458 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16459 503 or 504 here.
16460
16461 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16462 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16463 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16464 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16465 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16466
16467 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16468 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016469 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016470 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16471 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16472
16473 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16474 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16475 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16476 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16477 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16478 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16479 between haproxy and the server.
16480
16481 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16482 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16483 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16484 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16485 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16486 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16487 solution is to fix the application.
16488
16489 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16490 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16491 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16492 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16493 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16494 external attacks.
16495
16496 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16497 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016498 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016499 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16500 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16501
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016502 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16503 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16504 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016505 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16506 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016507
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016508 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16509 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16510 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16511 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016512 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16513 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16514 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16515 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16516 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016517
16518 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16519 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16520 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16521 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16522
16523 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16524 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16525 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16526 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16527
16528 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16529 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16530 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16531 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16532
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016533The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16534persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16535important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16536re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16537
16538 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16539
16540 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16541 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16542 set on a GET request.
16543
16544 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16545 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016546 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016547 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16548
16549 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16550 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16551 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16552
16553 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16554 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16555 already got a cookie.
16556
16557 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16558 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16559 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16560 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16561 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16562
16563 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16564 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16565 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16566
16567 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16568 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16569 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16570
16571 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16572 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16573
16574 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16575 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16576 then advertised in the response.
16577
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016578
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165798.6. Non-printable characters
16580-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016581
16582In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16583consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16584converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16585prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16586being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16587escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16588is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16589'}' when logging headers.
16590
16591Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16592issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16593containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16594
16595Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16596the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16597performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16598
16599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166008.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16601---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016602
16603Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16604achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016605section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016606cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16607the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16608the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016609locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016610not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16611user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16612a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16613wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16614
16615 Examples :
16616 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16617 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16618
16619 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16620 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16621
16622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166238.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16624---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016625
16626Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16627proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16628the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16629server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16630
16631Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16632response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016633section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016634
16635It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016636time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16637appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016638are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16639and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16640follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16641request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16642in the logs.
16643
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016644As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16645frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16646an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16647
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016648 Example :
16649 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16650 listen proxy-out
16651 mode http
16652 option httplog
16653 option logasap
16654 log global
16655 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16656
16657 # log the name of the virtual server
16658 capture request header Host len 20
16659
16660 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16661 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16662
16663 # log the beginning of the referrer
16664 capture request header Referer len 20
16665
16666 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16667 capture response header Server len 20
16668
16669 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16670 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16671
16672 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16673 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16674
16675 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16676 capture response header Via len 20
16677
16678 # log the URL location during a redirection
16679 capture response header Location len 20
16680
16681 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16682 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16683 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16684 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16685 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16686
16687 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16688 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16689 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16690 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016691 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016692
16693 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16694 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16695 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16696 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16697 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016698 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016699
16700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167018.9. Examples of logs
16702---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016703
16704These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16705them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16706reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16707
16708 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16709 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16710 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16711
16712 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16713 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16714
16715 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16716 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16717 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16718
16719 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16720 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16721
16722 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16723 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16724 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16725
16726 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016727 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016728 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16729 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16730
16731 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16732 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16733 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16734
16735 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16736 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016737 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016738 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16739 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16740 to return the 502 and not the server.
16741
16742 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016743 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016744
16745 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16746 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16747 Nothing was sent to any server.
16748
16749 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16750 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16751
16752 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16753 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16754 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16755 send a 408 return code to the client.
16756
16757 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16758 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16759
16760 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16761 5 seconds ("c----").
16762
16763 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16764 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016765 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016766
16767 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016768 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016769 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16770 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16771 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16772 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16773 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016774
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016775
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200167769. Supported filters
16777--------------------
16778
16779Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16780accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16781unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16782
16783See also : "filter"
16784
167859.1. Trace
16786----------
16787
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016788filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016789
16790 Arguments:
16791 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16792 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16793
16794 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16795 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16796 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16797 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16798
16799 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16800 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16801 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16802 amount of the parsed data.
16803
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016804 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16805
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016806This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16807callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16808information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16809filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16810
16811Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16812tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16813a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16814
16815
168169.2. HTTP compression
16817---------------------
16818
16819filter compression
16820
16821The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16822keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16823when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16824use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16825used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16826filters evaluation order.
16827
16828See also : "compression"
16829
16830
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200168319.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16832--------------------------------------------
16833
16834filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16835
16836 Arguments :
16837
16838 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16839 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16840 parsed.
16841
16842 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16843 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16844 part must be placed in its own scope.
16845
16846The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16847external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16848streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16849exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16850also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16851
16852SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16853the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16854
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016855For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016856"doc/SPOE.txt".
16857
16858Important note:
16859 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16860 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16861
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016862/*
16863 * Local variables:
16864 * fill-column: 79
16865 * End:
16866 */